SMSC FDC37C672QFP Enhanced super i/o controller with fast ir Datasheet

FDC37C672
Enhanced Super I/O
Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Product Features
5 Volt Operation
PC98/99 and ACPI 1.0 Compliant
ISA Plug-and-Play Compatible Register Set
Intelligent Auto Power Management
Serial Ports
− Two Full Function Serial Ports
− High Speed NS16C550A Compatible UARTs with
Send/Receive 16-Byte FIFOs
− Supports 230k and 460k Baud Programmable Baud
Rate Generator Modem Control Circuitry
− 480 Address and Eight IRQ Options
− Shadowed Write-Only Registers for ACPI Compliance
System Management Interrupt, Watchdog Timer
2.88MB Super I/O Floppy Disk Controller
Infrared Port
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
− Licensed CMOS 765B Floppy Disk Controller
− Software and Register Compatible with SMSC's
Proprietary 82077AA Compatible Core
− Supports Two Floppy Drives Directly
− Configurable Open Drain/Push-Pull Output Drivers
− Supports Vertical Recording Format
− 16-Byte Data FIFO
− 100% IBM Compatibility
− Detects All Overrun and Underrun Conditions
− Sophisticated Power Control Circuitry (PCC)
Including Multiple Powerdown Modes for Reduced
Power Consumption
− DMA Enable Logic
− Data Rate and Drive Control Registers
− 480 Address, Up to Eight IRQ and Three DMA
Options
Multi-Mode Parallel Port with ChiProtect
− Standard Mode IBM PC/XT, PC/AT, and PS/2
Compatible Bidirectional Parallel Port
− Enhanced Parallel Port (EPP) Compatible - EPP 1.7
and EPP 1.9 (IEEE 1284 Compliant)
− IEEE 1284 Compliant Enhanced Capabilities Port
(ECP)
− ChiProtect Circuitry for Protection Against Damage
Due to Printer Power-On
− 480 Address, Up to Eight IRQ and Three DMA
Options
Floppy Disk Available on Parallel Port Pins
Enhanced Digital Data Separator
− 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps, 500 Kbps, 300 Kbps, 250 Kbps Data
Rates
− Programmable Precompensation Modes
ISA Host Interface
−
−
−
−
−
−
Keyboard Controller
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
8042 Software Compatible
8 Bit Microcomputer
2k Bytes of Program ROM
256 Bytes of Data RAM
Four Open Drain Outputs Dedicated for
Keyboard/Mouse Interface
Asynchronous Access to Two Data Registers and
One Status Register
Supports Interrupt and Polling Access
8-Bit Counter Timer
Port 92 Support
8042 P12 and P16 Outputs
SMSC FDC37C672
Multiprotocol Infrared Interface
128-Byte Data FIFO
IrDA 1.1 Compliant
TEMIC/HP Module Support
Consumer IR
SHARP ASK IR
480 Address, Up to Eight IRQ and Three DMA
Options
16-Bit Address Qualification
8-Bit Data Bus
IOCHRDY for ECP and Fast IR
Three 8-Bit DMA Channels
Eight Direct Parallel IRQs
Serial IRQ Option Compatible with Serialized IRQ
Support for PCI Systems
100 Pin QFP and TQFP Packages
Page 1
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
ORDERING INFORMATION
Order Number(s):
FDC37C672QFP for 100 pin QFP package
FDC37C672TQFP for 100 pin TQFP package
80 Arkay Drive
Hauppauge, NY 11788
(631) 435-6000
FAX (631) 273-3123
Copyright © SMSC 2004. All rights reserved.
Circuit diagrams and other information relating to SMSC products are included as a means of illustrating typical applications. Consequently, complete
information sufficient for construction purposes is not necessarily given. Although the information has been checked and is believed to be accurate, no
responsibility is assumed for inaccuracies. SMSC reserves the right to make changes to specifications and product descriptions at any time without
notice. Contact your local SMSC sales office to obtain the latest specifications before placing your product order. The provision of this information does
not convey to the purchaser of the described semiconductor devices any licenses under any patent rights or other intellectual property rights of SMSC
or others. All sales are expressly conditional on your agreement to the terms and conditions of the most recently dated version of SMSC's standard
Terms of Sale Agreement dated before the date of your order (the "Terms of Sale Agreement"). The product may contain design defects or errors
known as anomalies which may cause the product's functions to deviate from published specifications. Anomaly sheets are available upon request.
SMSC products are not designed, intended, authorized or warranted for use in any life support or other application where product failure could cause
or contribute to personal injury or severe property damage. Any and all such uses without prior written approval of an Officer of SMSC and further
testing and/or modification will be fully at the risk of the customer. Copies of this document or other SMSC literature, as well as the Terms of Sale
Agreement, may be obtained by visiting SMSC’s website at http://www.smsc.com. SMSC is a registered trademark of Standard Microsystems
Corporation (“SMSC”). Product names and company names are the trademarks of their respective holders.
SMSC DISCLAIMS AND EXCLUDES ANY AND ALL WARRANTIES, INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION ANY AND ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND AGAINST INFRINGEMENT AND THE LIKE, AND ANY AND
ALL WARRANTIES ARISING FROM ANY COURSE OF DEALING OR USAGE OF TRADE.
IN NO EVENT SHALL SMSC BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INCIDENTAL, INDIRECT, SPECIAL, PUNITIVE, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES;
OR FOR LOST DATA, PROFITS, SAVINGS OR REVENUES OF ANY KIND; REGARDLESS OF THE FORM OF ACTION, WHETHER BASED ON
CONTRACT; TORT; NEGLIGENCE OF SMSC OR OTHERS; STRICT LIABILITY; BREACH OF WARRANTY; OR OTHERWISE; WHETHER OR
NOT ANY REMEDY OF BUYER IS HELD TO HAVE FAILED OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE, AND WHETHER OR NOT SMSC HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 2
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
FDC37C672 Datasheet Revision History
REVISION LEVEL
AND DATE
Rev. 10-29-03
Rev. 10-28-03
Rev. 10-28-03
Rev. 10-27-03
Rev. 10-27-03
Rev. 10-27-03
Rev. 06-09-97
Rev. 06-09-97
Rev. 06-09-97
Rev. 06-09-97
SMSC FDC37C672
SECTION/FIGURE/ENTRY
Ordering Information, page 2
Chapter 3 - Description of Pin Functions, page 12
Chapter 4 - Description of Multifunction Pins, page
15
Figure 2.2 - FDC37C672 100 Pin TQFP, page 11
Figure 23.2 - 100 Pin TQFP Package Outline,
14X14X1.4 Body, 2 MM Footprint, page 173
Features - Cover
Figure 2.1 - FDC37C672 100 Pin QFP, page 10
Section 6.1.4 - Tape Drive Register (TDR), page 24
Table 6.3 - Tape Select Bits, page 24
Table 19.1 - Configuration Registers, page 123
CORRECTION
Update order numbers for QFP and
TQFP packages.
Added TQFP values.
Added TQFP values.
Added TQFP pin layout.
Added TQFP package outline.
Added TQFP package.
Pin #90 added to Pin-Out.
Updated section.
Updated table.
Updated table.
Page 3
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table of Contents
FDC37C672 Datasheet Revision History .................................................................................................. 3
Chapter 1
Chapter 2
Chapter 3
3.1
General Description................................................................................................................ 9
Pin Configuration.................................................................................................................. 10
Description of Pin Functions ................................................................................................ 12
Buffer Type Descriptions ............................................................................................................................14
Chapter 4
Chapter 5
5.1
5.2
Description of Multifunction Pins .......................................................................................... 15
Functional Description.......................................................................................................... 17
Super I/O Registers....................................................................................................................................17
Host Processor Interface............................................................................................................................17
Chapter 6
Floppy Disk Controller .......................................................................................................... 18
6.1
FDC Internal Registers...............................................................................................................................18
6.1.1
Status Register A (SRA) .....................................................................................................................19
6.1.2
Status Register B (SRB) .....................................................................................................................21
6.1.3
Digital Output Register (DOR).............................................................................................................23
6.1.4
Tape Drive Register (TDR) .................................................................................................................24
6.1.5
Data Rate Select Register (DSR)........................................................................................................26
6.1.6
Main Status Register...........................................................................................................................29
6.1.7
Data Register (FIFO)...........................................................................................................................29
6.1.8
Digital Input Register (DIR) .................................................................................................................31
6.1.9
Configuration Control Register (CCR).................................................................................................33
6.1.10
Status Register Encoding ................................................................................................................34
6.2
RESET .......................................................................................................................................................36
6.2.1
RESET Pin (Hardware Reset).............................................................................................................36
6.2.2
DOR Reset vs. DSR Reset (Software Reset) .....................................................................................36
6.3
Modes of Operation....................................................................................................................................36
6.3.1
PC/AT mode - (IDENT high, MFM a "don't care") ...............................................................................36
6.3.2
PS/2 mode - (IDENT low, MFM high)..................................................................................................36
6.3.3
Model 30 mode - (IDENT low, MFM low) ............................................................................................36
6.4
DMA Transfers ...........................................................................................................................................37
6.5
Controller Phases.......................................................................................................................................37
6.5.1
Command Phase ................................................................................................................................37
6.5.2
Execution Phase .................................................................................................................................37
6.5.3
Data Transfer Termination ..................................................................................................................38
6.5.4
Result Phase.......................................................................................................................................39
Chapter 7
Chapter 8
Command Set/Descriptions ................................................................................................. 40
Instruction Set ...................................................................................................................... 43
8.1
Data Transfer Commands ..........................................................................................................................49
8.1.1
Read Data ...........................................................................................................................................49
8.1.2
Read Deleted Data..............................................................................................................................51
8.1.3
Read A Track ......................................................................................................................................51
8.1.4
Write Data ...........................................................................................................................................52
8.1.5
Write Deleted Data..............................................................................................................................53
8.1.6
Verify...................................................................................................................................................53
8.1.7
Format A Track ...................................................................................................................................54
8.2
Control Commands ....................................................................................................................................55
8.2.1
Read ID...............................................................................................................................................55
8.2.2
Recalibrate ..........................................................................................................................................55
8.2.3
Seek....................................................................................................................................................56
8.2.4
Sense Interrupt Status ........................................................................................................................56
8.2.5
Sense Drive Status .............................................................................................................................57
8.2.6
Specify ................................................................................................................................................57
8.2.7
Configure ............................................................................................................................................58
8.2.8
Version................................................................................................................................................59
8.2.9
Relative Seek ......................................................................................................................................59
8.2.10
Perpendicular Mode ........................................................................................................................60
8.3
LOCK .........................................................................................................................................................61
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 4
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
8.4
8.5
Enhanced DUMPREG................................................................................................................................61
Compatibility...............................................................................................................................................62
Chapter 9
Serial Port (UART) ............................................................................................................... 63
9.1
Register Description ...................................................................................................................................63
9.1.1
Receive Buffer Register (RB) ..............................................................................................................64
9.1.2
Transmit Buffer Register (TB) .............................................................................................................64
9.1.3
Interrupt Enable Register (IER) ...........................................................................................................64
9.1.4
FIFO Control Register (FCR) ..............................................................................................................65
9.1.5
Interrupt Identification Register (IIR) ...................................................................................................65
9.1.6
Line Control Register (LCR) ................................................................................................................67
9.1.7
Modem Control Register (MCR)..........................................................................................................68
9.1.8
Line Status Register (LSR) .................................................................................................................69
9.1.9
Modem Status Register (MSR) ...........................................................................................................71
9.1.10
Scratchpad Register (SCR) .............................................................................................................72
9.2
Programmable Baud Rate Generator (and Divisor Latches DLH, DLL) .....................................................72
9.2.1
Effect Of The Reset on Register File...................................................................................................72
9.3
FIFO Interrupt Mode Operation ..................................................................................................................72
9.4
FIFO Polled Mode Operation .....................................................................................................................73
9.5
Notes on Serial Port Operation ..................................................................................................................76
9.5.1
FIFO Mode Operation: ........................................................................................................................76
Chapter 10
Chapter 11
Chapter 12
Infrared Interface .................................................................................................................. 78
Fast IR .................................................................................................................................. 79
Parallel Port.......................................................................................................................... 80
12.1
IBM XT/AT Compatible, Bi-Directional and EPP Modes .........................................................................81
12.2
Extended Capabilities Parallel Port.........................................................................................................87
12.2.1
Vocabulary.......................................................................................................................................87
12.3
ISA Implementation Standard.................................................................................................................88
12.3.1
Register Definitions .........................................................................................................................90
12.4
Operation................................................................................................................................................96
12.4.1
Mode Switching/Software Control....................................................................................................96
12.4.2
Data Compression...........................................................................................................................97
12.4.3
Pin Definition ...................................................................................................................................97
12.4.4
ISA Connections..............................................................................................................................97
12.4.5
Interrupts .........................................................................................................................................98
12.4.6
FIFO Operation................................................................................................................................98
12.5
DMA Transfers........................................................................................................................................98
12.5.1
Programmed I/O Mode or Non-DMA Mode .....................................................................................99
12.5.2
Programmed I/O - Transfers from the FIFO to the Host ..................................................................99
12.5.3
Programmed I/O - Transfers from the Host to the FIFO ................................................................100
12.6
Parallel Port Floppy Disk Controller ......................................................................................................100
Chapter 13
Chapter 14
Auto Power Management................................................................................................... 102
Serial IRQ........................................................................................................................... 106
14.1
Serial Interrupts ....................................................................................................................................106
14.1.1
Timing Diagrams For IRQSER Cycle ............................................................................................106
14.1.2
IRQSER Cycle Control ..................................................................................................................107
14.1.3
IRQSER Data Frame.....................................................................................................................108
14.1.4
Stop Cycle Control.........................................................................................................................108
14.1.5
Latency ..........................................................................................................................................109
14.1.6
EOI/ISR Read Latency ..................................................................................................................109
14.1.7
AC/DC Specification Issue ............................................................................................................109
14.1.8
Reset and Initialization ..................................................................................................................109
Chapter 15
Chapter 16
Chapter 17
GP Index Registers ............................................................................................................ 110
Watch Dog Timer ............................................................................................................... 111
8042 Keyboard Controller Description ............................................................................... 112
17.1
Keyboard ISA Interface.........................................................................................................................112
17.1.1
Keyboard Data Write .....................................................................................................................113
17.1.2
Keyboard Data Read .....................................................................................................................113
17.1.3
Keyboard Command Write ............................................................................................................113
17.1.4
Keyboard Status Read ..................................................................................................................113
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 5
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
17.1.5
CPU-to-Host Communication ........................................................................................................113
17.1.6
Host-to-CPU Communication ........................................................................................................113
17.1.7
KIRQ..............................................................................................................................................114
17.1.8
MIRQ .............................................................................................................................................114
17.1.9
Gate A20 .......................................................................................................................................114
17.2
External Keyboard and Mouse Interface...............................................................................................114
17.3
Keyboard Power Management .............................................................................................................114
17.3.1
Soft Power Down Mode.................................................................................................................114
17.3.2
Hard Power Down Mode ...............................................................................................................115
17.4
Interrupts ..............................................................................................................................................115
17.5
Memory Configurations.........................................................................................................................115
17.5.1
Register Definitions .......................................................................................................................115
17.5.2
Status Register ..............................................................................................................................115
17.6
External Clock Signal............................................................................................................................116
17.7
Default Reset Conditions ......................................................................................................................116
17.8
GATEA20 and Keyboard Reset ............................................................................................................116
17.9
Port 92 Fast GATEA20 and Keyboard Reset .......................................................................................117
17.9.1
Port 92 Register.............................................................................................................................117
17.9.2
8042 P12 and P16 Functions ........................................................................................................118
Chapter 18
System Management Interrupt (SMI) ................................................................................. 120
18.1
Registers ..............................................................................................................................................120
18.1.1
SMI Enable Registers....................................................................................................................120
18.1.2
SMI Status Registers.....................................................................................................................120
Chapter 19
Configuration ...................................................................................................................... 121
19.1
System Elements..................................................................................................................................121
19.1.1
Primary Configuration Address Decoder .......................................................................................121
19.1.2
Entering the Configuration State....................................................................................................121
19.1.3
Exiting the Configuration State ......................................................................................................122
19.2
Configuration Sequence .......................................................................................................................122
19.2.1
Enter Configuration Mode..............................................................................................................122
19.2.2
Configuration Mode .......................................................................................................................122
19.2.3
Exit Configuration Mode ................................................................................................................122
19.2.4
Programming Example ..................................................................................................................123
19.2.5
Chip Level (Global) Control/Configuration Registers [0x00-0x2F] .................................................125
19.2.6
Logical Device Configuration/Control Registers [0x30-0xFF] ........................................................128
19.2.7
Note A. Logical Device IRQ and DMA Operation ..........................................................................132
19.2.8
SMSC Defined Logical Device Configuration Registers ................................................................132
Chapter 20
20.1
20.2
Operational Description...................................................................................................... 143
Maximum Guaranteed Ratings*............................................................................................................143
DC Electrical Characteristics ................................................................................................................143
Chapter 21
Chapter 22
Chapter 23
Timing Diagrams ................................................................................................................146
ECP Parallel Port Timing.................................................................................................... 164
Package Outlines ...............................................................................................................172
List of Figures
Figure 2.1 - FDC37C672 100 Pin QFP ........................................................................................................................10
Figure 2.2 - FDC37C672 100 Pin TQFP ......................................................................................................................11
Figure 4.1 - FDC37C672 Block Diagram......................................................................................................................16
Figure 11.1 - IR Interface Block Diagram .....................................................................................................................79
Figure 17.1 - Keyboard and Mouse Interface.............................................................................................................112
Figure 17.2 - Gate A20 Turn-On Sequence Timing....................................................................................................119
Figure 21.1 - IOW Timing for Port 92 .........................................................................................................................147
Figure 21.2 - Power-Up Timing ..................................................................................................................................147
Figure 21.3 - ISA Write...............................................................................................................................................148
Figure 21.4 - ISA Read ..............................................................................................................................................149
Figure 21.5 - Internal 8042 CPU Timing.....................................................................................................................150
Figure 21.6 - Input Clock Timing ................................................................................................................................151
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 6
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Figure 21.7 - Reset Timing.........................................................................................................................................151
Figure 21.8 - DMA Timing (Single Transfer Mode).....................................................................................................152
Figure 21.9 - DMA Timing (Burst Transfer Mode) ......................................................................................................153
Figure 21.10 - Disk Drive Timing (At Mode Only).......................................................................................................154
Figure 21.11 - Serial Port Timing ...............................................................................................................................155
Figure 21.12 - Parallel Port Timing.............................................................................................................................156
Figure 21.13 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Write Cycle.................................................................................................157
Figure 21.14 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Read Cycle ................................................................................................159
Figure 21.15 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Write Cycle.................................................................................................161
Figure 21.16 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Read Cycle ................................................................................................163
Figure 22.1 - Parallel Port FIFO Timing.......................................................................................................................165
Figure 22.2 - ECP Parallel Port Forward Timing..........................................................................................................166
Figure 22.3 - ECP Parallel Port Reverse Timing .........................................................................................................167
Figure 22.4 - IrDA Receive Timing .............................................................................................................................168
Figure 22.5 - IrDA Transmit Timing ............................................................................................................................169
Figure 22.6 - Amplitude Shift Keyed IR Receive Timing ............................................................................................170
Figure 22.7 - Amplitude Shift Keyed IR Transmit Timing ...........................................................................................171
Figure 23.1 - 100 Pin QFP Package Outline and Parameters .....................................................................................172
Figure 23.2 - 100 Pin TQFP Package Outline, 14X14X1.4 Body, 2 MM Footprint .......................................................173
List of Tables
Table 5.1 - Super I/O Block Addresses .........................................................................................................................17
Table 6.1 - Status, Data and Control Registers .............................................................................................................18
Table 6.2 - Drive Activation Values ...............................................................................................................................24
Table 6.3 - Tape Select Bits..........................................................................................................................................24
Table 6.4 - Internal 2 Drive Decode - Normal ................................................................................................................24
Table 6.5 - Internal 2 Drive Decode - Drives 0 and 1 Swapped .....................................................................................25
Table 6.6 - Media ID1...................................................................................................................................................26
Table 6.7 - Media ID0...................................................................................................................................................26
Table 6.8 - Drive Type ID..............................................................................................................................................26
Table 6.9 - Precompensation Delays ............................................................................................................................27
Table 6.10 - Data Rates ...............................................................................................................................................28
Table 6.11 - DRVDEN Mapping....................................................................................................................................28
Table 6.12 - Default Precompensation Delays ..............................................................................................................28
Table 6.14 - FIFO Service Delay ....................................................................................................................................30
Table 6.15 - Status Register 0 ......................................................................................................................................34
Table 6.16 - Status Register 1 ......................................................................................................................................34
Table 6.17 - Status Register 2 ......................................................................................................................................35
Table 6.18 - Status Register 3 ......................................................................................................................................35
Table 7.1 - Description of Command Symbols ..............................................................................................................40
Table 8.1 - Sector Sizes ...............................................................................................................................................50
Table 8.2 - Effects of MT and N Bits .............................................................................................................................50
Table 8.3 - Skip Bit vs Read Data Command ................................................................................................................51
Table 8.4 - Skip Bit vs. Read Deleted Data Command ..................................................................................................51
Table 8.5 - Result Phase Table.....................................................................................................................................52
Table 8.6 - Verify Command Result Phase Table..........................................................................................................53
Table 8.7 - Format Fields..............................................................................................................................................54
Table 8.8 - Typical Values for Formatting......................................................................................................................55
Table 8.9 - Interrupt Identification..................................................................................................................................57
Table 8.10 - Drive Control Delays (ms) .........................................................................................................................58
Table 8.11 - Effects of WGATE and GAP Bits...............................................................................................................61
Table 9.1 - Addressing the Serial Port...........................................................................................................................63
Table 9.2 - Interrupt Control Table ................................................................................................................................67
Table 9.3 - Baud Rates Using 1.8462 MHz Clock for <= 38.4K; Using 1.8432MHz Clock for 115.2k; Using 3.6864MHz
Clock for 230.4k; Using 7.3728 MHz Clock for 460.8k..........................................................................................73
Table 9.4 - Reset Function Table..................................................................................................................................74
Table 9.5 - Register Summary for an Individual UART Channel ..................................................................................75
Table 11.1 - DRVDEN1 MUXING.................................................................................................................................79
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 7
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 12.1 - Parallel Port Connector .............................................................................................................................81
Table 12.2 - EPP Pin Descriptions ................................................................................................................................86
Table 12.3 - ECP Pin Descriptions................................................................................................................................89
Table 12.4 - ECP Register Definitions...........................................................................................................................90
Table 12.5 - Mode Descriptions ....................................................................................................................................90
Table 12.6A - Extended Control Register......................................................................................................................95
Table 12.7 - Forward Channel Commands (HostAck Low) Reverse Channel Commands (PeripAck Low) .................97
Table 12.8 - FDC Parallel Port Pins ............................................................................................................................101
Table 13.1 - PC/AT and PS/2 Available Registers.......................................................................................................103
Table 13.2 - State of System Pins in Auto Powerdown................................................................................................104
Table 13.3 - State of Floppy Disk Drive Interface Pins in Powerdown..........................................................................104
Table 14.1 - IRQSER Sampling Periods ....................................................................................................................108
Table 15.1 - GP Index and Data Register ...................................................................................................................110
Table 15.2- Index and Data Register Normal (Run) Mode...........................................................................................110
Table 17.1 - ISA I/O Address Map ..............................................................................................................................113
Table 17.2 - Host Interface Flags................................................................................................................................113
Table 17.3 - Status Register .......................................................................................................................................115
Table 17.4 - Resets ....................................................................................................................................................116
Table 19.1 - Configuration Registers ..........................................................................................................................123
Table 19.2 - Chip Level Registers...............................................................................................................................125
Table 19.3 - Logical Device Registers.........................................................................................................................128
Table 19.4 - I/O Base Address Configuration Register Description..............................................................................130
Table 19.5 - Interrupt Select Configuration Register Description .................................................................................131
Table 19.6 - DMA Channel Select Configuration Register Description.........................................................................131
Table 19.7 - Floppy Disk Controller, Logical Device 0 [Logical Device Number = 0x00]...............................................133
Table 19.8 - Parallel Port, Logical Device 3 [Logical Device Number = 0x03] ..............................................................134
Table 19.9 - Serial Port 1, Logical Device 4 [Logical Device Number = 0x04]..............................................................135
Table 19.10 - Serial Port 2, Logical Device 5 [Logical Device Number = 0x05]............................................................136
Table 19.11 - KYBD, Logical Device 7 [Logical Device Number = 0x07] .....................................................................137
Table 19.12 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08] ............................................................137
Table 19.13 - nRTS MUXING ....................................................................................................................................139
Table 19.14 - nCTS2 MUXING...................................................................................................................................139
Table 19.15 - nDTR2 MUXING ..................................................................................................................................139
Table 19.16 - nDSR2 MUXING ..................................................................................................................................140
Table 19.17 - nDCD2 MUXING ..................................................................................................................................140
Table 19.18 - nRI2 MUXING ......................................................................................................................................140
Table 19.19 - DRQ3 MUXING....................................................................................................................................140
Table 19.20 - nDACK3 MUXING................................................................................................................................141
Table 19.21 - SER_IRQ MUXING ..............................................................................................................................141
Table 19.22 - PCI_CLK MUXING...............................................................................................................................141
Table 19.23 - DRVDEN1 MUXING.............................................................................................................................141
Table 19.24 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08] ............................................................141
Table 21.1 - ISA Read Timing Parameters ................................................................................................................149
Table 21.2 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Cycle Timing Parameters ..............................................................................158
Table 21.3 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Read Cycle Timing Parameters ....................................................................160
Table 21.4 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Write Cycle Parameters ................................................................................162
Table 21.5 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Read Cycle Parameters ................................................................................163
Table 23.1 - 100 Pin TQFP Package Parameters .......................................................................................................173
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 8
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 1
General Description
The FDC37C672 with Consumer IR and IrDA v1.1 support incorporates a keyboard interface, SMSC's true
CMOS 765B floppy disk controller, advanced digital data separator, two 16C550 compatible UARTs, one
Multi-Mode parallel port which includes ChiProtect circuitry plus EPP and ECP, on-chip 24 mA AT bus
drivers, two floppy direct drive support, Intelligent power management and SMI support. The true CMOS
765B core provides 100% compatibility with IBM PC/XT and PC/AT architectures in addition to providing
data overflow and underflow protection. The SMSC advanced digital data separator incorporates SMSC's
patented data separator technology, allowing for ease of testing and use. Both on-chip UARTs are
compatible with the NS16C550. The parallel port is compatible with IBM PC/AT architecture, as well as
IEEE 1284 EPP and ECP. The FDC37C672 incorporates sophisticated power control circuitry (PCC).
The PCC supports multiple low power down modes.
The FDC37C672 supports the ISA Plug-and-Play Standard (Version 1.0a) and provides the recommended
functionality to support Windows '95. The I/O Address, DMA Channel and Hardware IRQ of each logical
device in the FDC37C672 may be reprogrammed through the internal configuration registers. There are
480 I/O address location options, 8 parallel IRQs, an optional Serialized IRQ interface, and three DMA
channels.
The FDC37C672 does not require any external filter components and is therefore easy to use and offers
lower system costs and reduced board area. The FDC37C672 is software and register compatible with
SMSC's proprietary 82077AA core.
IBM, PC/XT and PC/AT are registered trademarks and PS/2 is a trademark of International Business Machines Corporation. SMSC is
a registered trademark and Ultra I/O, ChiProtect, and Multi-Mode are trademarks of Standard Microsystems Corporation.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 9
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Pin Configuration
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
FDC37C67x
FDC37C672
100 PIN
100
PINQFP
QFP
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
nACK
BUSY
PE
SLCT
VSS
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
nSLCTIN
n INIT
VCC
A20M
KBDRST
IRTX
IRRX
VSS
MCLKK
MDAT
KCLK
KDAT
IOCHRDY
TC
VCC
DRQ3/P12
nDACK3/P16
nC S/SA11
PCI_CLK/IRQ4
SER_I RQ/IRQ3
nIOR
nIOW
AEN
SD0
SD1
SD2
SD3
VSS
SD4
SD5
SD6
SD7
RESET_DRV
nDACK1
DRQ2
nDACK2
DRQ1
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
DRVDEN0
DRVDEN1/IRMODE
nMTRO
nDS1
nDS0
nMTR1
VSS
nDIR
nSTEP
nWDATA
nWGATE
nHDSEL
nINDEX
nTRK0
nWRTPRT
nRDATA
nD SKCHG
VCC
CLOCKI
SA0
SA1
SA2
SA3
SA4
SA5
SA6
SA7
SA8
SA9
SA10
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
nDTR2/ SA14/IRQ7
nCTS2/ SA13/IRQ6
nRTS2 /SA12/IRQ5
nDSR2/SA15/IRQ10/nSMI
TXD2/IRTX
RXD2/IRRX
nDCD2/P12/IRQ11
VCC
nRI2/P16/IRQ12
nDCD1
nRI1
nDTR1
nCTS1
nRTS1/SYSOP
nDSR1
TXD1
RXD1
nSTROBE
nALF
nERROR
Chapter 2
Figure 2.1 - FDC37C672 100 Pin QFP
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 10
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
DRVDEN1/IRMODE
DRVDEN0
nDTR2/SA14/IRQ7
nCTS2/SA13/IRQ6
nRTS2/SA12/IRQ5
nDSR2/SA15/IRQ10/nSMI
TXD2/IRTX
RXD2/IRRX
nDCD2/P12/IRQ11
VCC
nRI2/P16/IRQ12
nDCD1
nRI1
nDTR1
nCTS1
nRTS1/SYSOP
nDSR1
TXD1
RXD1
nSTROBE
nALF
nERROR
nACK
BUSY
PE
Datasheet
FDC37C672
100 PIN TQFP
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
SLCT
VSS
PD7
PD6
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PD1
PD0
nSLCTIN
nINIT
VCC
A20M
KBDRST
IRTX
IRRX
VSS
MCLK
MDAT
KCLK
KDAT
IOCHRDY
TC
VCC
SA8
SA9
SA10
nCS/SA11
PCI_CLK/IRQ4
SER_IRQ/IRQ3
nIOR
nIOW
AEN
SD0
SD1
SD2
SD3
VSS
SD4
SD5
SD6
SD7
RESET_DRV
nDACK1
DRQ2
nDACK2
DRQ1
nDACK3/P16
DRQ3/P12
nMTR0
nDS1
nDS0
nMTR1
VSS
nDIR
nSTEP
nWDATA
nWGATE
nHDSEL
nINDEX
nTRK0
nWRTPRT
nRDATA
nDSKCHG
VCC
CLOCKI
SA0
SA1
SA2
SA3
SA4
SA5
SA6
SA7
Figure 2.2 - FDC37C672 100 Pin TQFP
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 11
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 3
Description of Pin Functions
PIN NO.
QFP/TQFP
NAME
37:40,
42:45 /
35:38,
40:43
20:30 /
18:28
31 / 29
36 / 34
55 / 53
46 / 44
33 / 31
System Data Bus
TOTAL
PROCESSOR/HOST INTERFACE (34)
8
SYMBOL
BUFFER
TYPE
SD[0:7]
IO24
11-bit System Address Bus
11
SA[0:10]
I
Chip Select/SA11 (Note 3.2)
Address Enable
I/O Channel Ready
ISA Reset Drive
Serial IRQ/Parallel IRQ_3
1
1
1
1
1
nCS/SA11
AEN
IOCHRDY
RESET_DRV
SER_IRQ/
IRQ3
32 / 30
PCI Clock for Serial IRQ (33MHz/30MHz)/ Parallel
IRQ_4
1
PCI_CLK/
IRQ4
50 / 48
48 / 46
52 / 50
47 / 45
49 / 47
51 / 49
DMA Request 1
DMA Request 2
DMA Request 3/8042 P12
DMA Acknowledge 1
DMA Acknowledge 2
DMA Acknowledge 3/8042 P16
1
1
1
1
1
1
54 / 52
34 / 32
35 / 33
Terminal Count
I/O Read
I/O Write
1
1
1
DRQ1
DRQ2
DRQ3/P12
nDACK1
nDACK2
nDACK3/
P16
TC
nIOR
nIOW
I
I
OD24
IS
IO24/O24/
D24
(Note 3.1)
IO24/O24/
OD24
(Note 3.1)
O24
O24
O24/IO24
I
I
I/IO24
1
CLOCKI
ICLK
1
1
IRRX
IRTX
I
O24
I
I
I
CLOCKS (1)
19 / 17
14.318MHz Clock Input
INFRARED INTERFACE (2)
61 / 59
62 / 60
Infrared Rx
Infrared Tx
POWER PINS (8)
18,53,
65,93 /
16, 51, 63,
91
7,41, 60,76 /
5, 39, 58, 74
Power
VCC
Ground
VSS
FDD INTERFACE (16)
16 / 14
11 / 9
10 / 8
SMSC FDC37C672
Read Disk Data
Write Gate
Write Disk Data
1
1
1
Page 12
DATASHEET
nRDATA
nWGATE
nWDATA
IS
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PIN NO.
QFP/TQFP
12 /10
8/6
9/7
17 / 15
5/3
4/2
3/1
6/4
15 / 13
14 / 12
13 / 11
1 / 99
2 / 100
NAME
Head Select
Step Direction
Step Pulse
Disk Change
Drive Select 0
Drive Select 1
Motor On 0
Motor On 1
Write Protected
Track 0
Index Pulse Input
Drive Density Select 0
Drive Density Select 1/IR Mode Select/IRRX3
TOTAL
SYMBOL
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
nHDSEL
nDIR
nSTEP
nDSKCHG
nDS0
nDS1
nMTR0
nMTR1
nWRTPRT
nTRKO
nINDEX
DRVDEN0
DRVDEN1/
IRMODE/
IRRX3
95 / 93
96 / 94
98 / 96
SERIAL PORT 1 INTERFACE (8)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
SERIAL PORT 2 INTERFACE (8)
Receive Serial Data 2/Infrared Rx
1
Transmit Serial Data 2/Infrared Tx
1
Request to Send 2/Sys Addr 12/ Parallel IRQ_5
1
99 / 97
Clear to Send 2/Sys Addr 13/ Parallel IRQ_6
1
nCTS2/SA13/IR
Q6
100 / 98
Data Terminal Ready/Sys Addr 14/ Parallel IRQ_7
1
nDTR2/SA14/I
RQ7
97 / 95
Data Set Ready 2/Sys Addr 15/ Parallel
IRQ_10/nSMI
1
94 / 92
Data Carrier Detect 2/8042 P12/ Parallel IRQ_11
1
nDSR2/SA15/I
RQ10/
nSMI
nDCD2/P12/
IRQ11
92 / 90
Ring Indicator 2/8042 P16/Parallel IRQ_12
1
68:75 /
66:73
Parallel Port Data Bus
84 / 82
85 / 83
87 / 85
88 / 86
89 / 87
86 / 84
91 / 89
90 / 88
SMSC FDC37C672
Receive Serial Data 1
Transmit Serial Data 1
Request to Send 1
Clear to Send 1
Data Terminal Ready 1
Data Set Ready 1
Data Carrier Detect 1
Ring Indicator 1
PARALLEL PORT INTERFACE (17)
8
BUFFER
TYPE
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
IS
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
O24/OD24
IS
IS
IS
O24/OD24
O24/OD24/O
24/I
RXD1
TXD1
nRTS1/ SYSOP
nCTS1
nDTR1
nDSR1
nDCD1
nRI1
I
O4
O4/I
I
O4
I
I
I
RXD2/IRRX
TXD2/IRTX
nRTS2/SA12/IR
Q5
I
O24
O4/I/O24/
OD24
(Note 3.1)
I/I/O24/ OD24
(Note 3.1)
O4/I/O24/
OD24
(Note 3.1)
I/I/O24/OD 24
(Note 3.1)
nRI2/P16/
IRQ12
PD[0:7]
Page 13
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
I/IO24/O24/O
D24
(Note 3.1)
I/IO24/O24/O
D24
(Note 3.1)
IO24
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PIN NO.
QFP/TQFP
67 / 65
66 / 64
82 / 80
83 / 81
79 / 77
80 / 78
78 / 76
77 / 75
81 / 79
NAME
TOTAL
56 / 54
57 / 55
58 / 56
59 / 57
63 / 61
Printer Select
1
Initiate Output
1
Auto Line Feed
1
Strobe Signal
1
Busy Signal
1
Acknowledge Handshake
1
Paper End
1
Printer Selected
1
Error at Printer
1
KEYBOARD/MOUSE INTERFACE (6)
Keyboard Data
1
Keyboard Clock
1
Mouse Data
1
Mouse Clock
1
Keyboard Reset
1
64 / 62
Gate A20
1
SYMBOL
nSLCTIN
nINIT
nALF
nSTROBE
BUSY
nACK
PE
SLCT
nERROR
KDAT
KCLK
MDAT
MCLK
KBDRST
(Note 3.4)
A20M
BUFFER
TYPE
OD24/O24
OD24/O24
OD24/O24
OD24/O24
I
I
I
I
I
IOD16P
IOD16P
IOD16P
IOD16P
O4
O4
Note 3.1 The interrupt request is output on one of the IRQx signals as an 024 buffer type. If EPP or ECP Mode is
enabled, this output is pulsed low, then released to allow sharing of interrupts. In this case, the buffer type
is OD24. Refer to the configuration section for more information.
Note 3.2 For 12-bit addressing, SA0:SA11 only, nCS should be tied to GND. For 16-bit external address
qualification, address bits SA11:SA15 can be "ORed" together and applied to nCS. The nCS pin functions
as SA11 in full 16-bit Internal Address Qualification Mode. CR24.6 controls the FDC37C672 addressing
modes.
Note 3.3 The "n" as the first letter of a signal name indicates an "Active Low" signal.
Note 3.4 KBDRST is active low.
3.1
Buffer Type Descriptions
I
Input, TTL compatible.
IS
Input with Schmitt trigger.
IOD16P
Input/Output, 16mA sink, 90uA pull-up.
IO24
Input/Output, 24mA sink, 12mA source.
IO4
Input/Output, 4mA sink, 2mA source.
O4
Output, 4mA sink, 2mA source.
O24
Output, 24mA sink, 12mA source.
OD24
Output, Open Drain, 24mA sink.
ICLK
Clock Input
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 14
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 4
PIN NO.
QFP/TQFP
2 / 100
32 / 30
33 / 31
51 / 49
52 / 50
92 / 90
94 / 92
95 / 93
96 / 94
97 / 95
98 / 96
99 / 97
100 / 98
Description of Multifunction Pins
ORIGINAL
FUNCTION
DRVDEN1
PCICLK
SERIRQ
nDACK3
DRQ3
nRI2
nDCD2
RXD2
TXD2
nDSR2
nRTS2
nCTS2
nDTR2
ALTERNATE
FUNCTION 1
IR MODE
IRQ4
IRQ3
8042 P16
8042 P12
8042 P16
8042 P12
IRRX
IRTX
SA15
SA12
SA13
SA14
ALTERNATE
FUNCTION 2
IRRX3
IRQ12
IRQ11
IRQ10
IRQ5
IRQ6
IRQ7
DEFAULT
DRVDEN1
PCICLK
SERIRQ
nDACK3
DRQ3
nRI2
nDCD2
RXD2
TXD2
nDSR2
nRTS2
nCTS2
nDTR2
NOTE
Note 4.1
Note 4.2
Note 4.2
Note 4.3
Note 4.3
Note 4.4
Note 4.4
Note 4.5
Note 4.5
Note 4.6
Note 4.6
Note 4.6
Note 4.6
Note 4.1 Controlled by IRMODSEL(LD8:CRC0.0) and IRRX3SEL(LD8:CRC0.4)
Note 4.2 Controlled by SERIRQSEL(LD8:CRC0.2)
Note 4.3 Controlled by DMA3SEL(LD8:CRC0.1)
Note 4.4 Controlled by 8042COMSEL(LD8:CRC0.3) and SERIRQSEL(LD8:CRC0.2)
Note 4.5 Controlled by IR Option Register( LD5:CRF1.6)
Note 4.6 Controlled by 16 bit Address Qual.(CR24.6) and SERIRQSEL(LD8:CRC0.2)
For more information, refer to Table 19.13 through Table 19.23.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 15
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
nSMI
SMI
*
WDT
MULTI-MODE
PARALLEL
PORT/FDC
MUX
DATA BUS
SER_IRQ *
PCI_CLK *
SERIAL
IRQ
PD0-7
BUSY, SLCT, PE,
nERROR, nACK
nSTB, nSLCTIN,
nINIT, nALF
ADDRESS BUS
nIOR
CONFIGURATION
nIOW
16C550
COMPATIBLE
SERIAL
PORT 1
REGISTERS
AEN
*
SA[0:12] (nCS)
SA[13-15]
*
HOST
IRR3/Mode*
CPU
16C550
COMPATIBLE
SERIAL
PORT 2 WITH
INFRARED
WDATA
INTERFACE
WCLOCK
DRQ[1:3]*
SMSC
PROPRIETARY
82077
COMPATIBLE
VERTICAL
FLOPPYDISK
CONTROLLER
CORE
*
TC
IRQ[3:7,10:12]
nDSR1, nDCD1, nRI1, nDTR1
CONTROL BUS
SD[O:7]
nDACK[1:3]
TXD1, nCTS1, nRTS1
RXD1
*
DIGITAL
DATA
SEPARATOR
WITH WRITE
PRECOMPENSATION
8042
RDATA
IOCHRDY
TXD2(IRTX), nCTS2, nRTS2 *
RXD2(IRRX)*
nDSR2, nDCD2, nRI2, nDTR2 *
RCLOCK
RESET_DRV
IRRX, IRTX*
CLOCK
KCLK
KDATA
MCLK
MDATA
GATEA20, KBDRST
P12, P16 *
GEN
Vcc
Vss
ICLOCK
(14.318)
nINDEX DENSEL nDS0,1
nTRK0
nDIR nMTR0,1
* nWDATA nRDATA
nDSKCHG
nSTEP DRVDEN0
nWRPRT
nHDSEL DRVDEN1
nWGATE
* Denotes Multifunction Pins
Figure 4.1 - FDC37C672 Block Diagram
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 16
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 5
5.1
Functional Description
Super I/O Registers
The address map, shown below in Table 5.1, shows the addresses of the different blocks of the Super I/O
immediately after power up. The base addresses of the FDC, serial and parallel ports can be moved via
the configuration registers. Some addresses are used to access more than one register.
5.2
Host Processor Interface
The host processor communicates with the FDC37C672 through a series of read/write registers. The port
addresses for these registers are shown in Table 5.1. Register access is accomplished through
programmed I/O or DMA transfers. All registers are 8 bits wide. All host interface output buffers are
capable of sinking a minimum of 12 mA.
Table 5.1 - Super I/O Block Addresses
ADDRESS
BLOCK NAME
Base+(0-5) and +(7)
Base+(0-7)
Base1+(0-7)
Base2+(0-7)
Floppy Disk
Serial Port Com 1
Serial Port Com 2
Base+(0-3)
Base+(0-7)
Base+(0-3), +(400-402)
Base+(0-7), +(400-402)
60, 64
Note:
Parallel Port
SPP
EPP
ECP
ECP+EPP+SPP
KYBD
LOGICAL
DEVICE
0
4
5
NOTES
IR Support
Fast IR
3
7
Refer to the configuration register descriptions for setting the base address
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 17
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 6
Floppy Disk Controller
The Floppy Disk Controller (FDC) provides the interface between a host microprocessor and the floppy
disk drives. The FDC integrates the functions of the Formatter/Controller, Digital Data Separator, Write
Precompensation and Data Rate Selection logic for an IBM XT/AT compatible FDC. The true CMOS 765B
core guarantees 100% IBM PC XT/AT compatibility in addition to providing data overflow and underflow
protection.
The FDC is compatible to the 82077AA using SMSC's proprietary floppy disk controller core.
6.1
FDC Internal Registers
The Floppy Disk Controller contains eight internal registers which facilitate the interfacing between the host
microprocessor and the disk drive. Table 6.1 shows the addresses required to access these registers.
Registers other than the ones shown are not supported. The rest of the description assumes that the
primary addresses have been selected.
Table 6.1 - Status, Data and Control Registers
PRIMARY
ADDRESS
3F0
3F1
3F2
3F3
3F4
3F4
3F5
3F6
3F7
3F7
SMSC FDC37C672
(Shown with base addresses of 3F0 and 370)
SECONDARY
R/W
REGISTER
ADDRESS
Status Register A (SRA)
R
370
Status Register B (SRB)
R
371
Digital Output Register (DOR)
R/W
372
Tape Drive Register (TSR)
R/W
373
Main Status Register (MSR)
R
374
Data Rate Select Register (DSR)
W
374
Data (FIFO)
R/W
375
Reserved
376
Digital Input Register (DIR)
R
377
Configuration Control Register (CCR)
W
377
Page 18
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.1
Status Register A (SRA)
Address 3F0 READ ONLY
This register is read-only and monitors the state of the FINTR pin and several disk interface pins in PS/2
and Model 30 modes. The SRA can be accessed at any time when in PS/2 mode. In the PC/AT mode the
data bus pins D0 - D7 are held in a high impedance state for a read of address 3F0.
PS/2 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
INT
PENDING
0
6
nDRV2
5
STEP
N/A
0
4
3
2
nTRK0 HDSEL nINDX
N/A
0
N/A
1
nWP
0
DIR
N/A
0
BIT 0 DIRECTION
Active high status indicating the direction of head movement. A logic "1" indicates inward direction; a logic
"0" indicates outward direction.
BIT 1 nWRITE PROTECT
Active low status of the WRITE PROTECT disk interface input. A logic "0" indicates that the disk is write
protected.
BIT 2 nINDEX
Active low status of the INDEX disk interface input.
BIT 3 HEAD SELECT
Active high status of the HDSEL disk interface input. A logic "1" selects side 1 and a logic "0" selects side
0.
BIT 4 nTRACK 0
Active low status of the TRK0 disk interface input.
BIT 5 STEP
Active high status of the STEP output disk interface output pin.
BIT 6 nDRV2
Active low status of the DRV2 disk interface input pin, indicating that a second drive has been installed.
BIT 7 INTERRUPT PENDING
Active high bit indicating the state of the Floppy Disk Interrupt output.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 19
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
7
INT
PENDING
6
DRQ
0
0
RESET
COND.
5
STEP
F/F
0
4
3
TRK0 nHDSEL
N/A
1
2
INDX
1
WP
0
nDIR
N/A
N/A
1
BIT 0 nDIRECTION
Active low status indicating the direction of head movement. A logic "0" indicates inward direction; a logic
"1" indicates outward direction.
BIT 1 WRITE PROTECT
Active high status of the WRITE PROTECT disk interface input. A logic "1" indicates that the disk is write
protected.
BIT 2 INDEX
Active high status of the INDEX disk interface input.
BIT 3 nHEAD SELECT
Active low status of the HDSEL disk interface input. A logic "0" selects side 1 and a logic "1" selects side
0.
BIT 4 TRACK 0
Active high status of the TRK0 disk interface input.
BIT 5 STEP
Active high status of the latched STEP disk interface output pin. This bit is latched with the STEP output
going active, and is cleared with a read from the DIR register, or with a hardware or software reset.
BIT 6 DMA REQUEST
Active high status of the DRQ output pin.
BIT 7 INTERRUPT PENDING
Active high bit indicating the state of the Floppy Disk Interrupt output.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 20
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.2
Status Register B (SRB)
Address 3F1 READ ONLY
This register is read-only and monitors the state of several disk interface pins in PS/2 and Model 30
modes. The SRB can be accessed at any time when in PS/2 mode. In the PC/AT mode the data bus pins
D0 - D7 are held in a high impedance state for a read of address 3F1.
PS/2 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
1
6
1
1
1
5
4
3
2
DRIVE WDATA RDATA WGATE
SEL0 TOGGLE TOGGLE
0
0
0
0
1
MOT
EN1
0
0
MOT
EN0
0
BIT 0 MOTOR ENABLE 0
Active high status of the MTR0 disk interface output pin. This bit is low after a hardware reset and
unaffected by a software reset.
BIT 1 MOTOR ENABLE 1
Active high status of the MTR1 disk interface output pin. This bit is low after a hardware reset and
unaffected by a software reset.
BIT 2 WRITE GATE
Active high status of the WGATE disk interface output.
BIT 3 READ DATA TOGGLE
Every inactive edge of the RDATA input causes this bit to change state.
BIT 4 WRITE DATA TOGGLE
Every inactive edge of the WDATA input causes this bit to change state.
BIT 5 DRIVE SELECT 0
Reflects the status of the Drive Select 0 bit of the DOR (address 3F2 bit 0). This bit is cleared after a
hardware reset and it is unaffected by a software reset.
BIT 6 RESERVED
Always read as a logic "1".
BIT 7 RESERVED
Always read as a logic "1".
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 21
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
nDRV2
6
nDS1
5
nDS0
N/A
1
1
4
WDATA
F/F
0
3
RDATA
F/F
2
WGATE
F/F
1
nDS3
0
nDS2
0
0
1
1
BIT 0 nDRIVE SELECT 2
Active low status of the DS2 disk interface output.
BIT 1 nDRIVE SELECT 3
Active low status of the DS3 disk interface output.
BIT 2 WRITE GATE
Active high status of the latched WGATE output signal. This bit is latched by the active going edge of
WGATE and is cleared by the read of the DIR register.
BIT 3 READ DATA
Active high status of the latched RDATA output signal. This bit is latched by the inactive going edge of
RDATA and is cleared by the read of the DIR register.
BIT 4 WRITE DATA
Active high status of the latched WDATA output signal. This bit is latched by the inactive going edge of
WDATA and is cleared by the read of the DIR register. This bit is not gated with WGATE.
BIT 5 nDRIVE SELECT 0
Active low status of the DS0 disk interface output.
BIT 6 nDRIVE SELECT 1
Active low status of the DS1 disk interface output.
BIT 7 nDRV2
Active low status of the DRV2 disk interface input.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 22
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.3
Digital Output Register (DOR)
Address 3F2 READ/WRITE
The DOR controls the drive select and motor enables of the disk interface outputs. It also contains the
enable for the DMA logic and a software reset bit. The contents of the DOR are unaffected by a software
reset. The DOR can be written to at any time.
RESET
COND.
7
MOT
EN3
0
6
MOT
EN2
0
5
MOT
EN1
0
4
MOT
EN0
0
3
2
1
0
DMAEN nRESE DRIVE DRIVE
T
SEL1
SEL0
0
0
0
0
BIT 0 and 1 DRIVE SELECT
These two bits are binary encoded for the four drive selects DS0 -DS3, thereby allowing only one drive to
be selected at one time.
BIT 2 nRESET
A logic "0" written to this bit resets the Floppy disk controller. This reset will remain active until a logic "1"
is written to this bit. This software reset does not affect the DSR and CCR registers, nor does it affect the
other bits of the DOR register. The minimum reset duration required is 100ns, therefore toggling this bit by
consecutive writes to this register is a valid method of issuing a software reset.
BIT 3 DMAEN
PC/AT and Model 30 Mode:
Writing this bit to logic "1" will enable the DRQ, nDACK, TC and FINTR outputs. This bit being a logic "0"
will disable the nDACK and TC inputs, and hold the DRQ and FINTR outputs in a high impedance state.
This bit is a logic "0" after a reset and in these modes.
PS/2 Mode:
In this mode the DRQ, nDACK, TC and FINTR pins are always enabled. During a reset, the DRQ,
nDACK, TC, and FINTR pins will remain enabled, but this bit will be cleared to a logic "0".
BIT 4 MOTOR ENABLE 0
This bit controls the MTR0 disk interface output. A logic "1" in this bit will cause the output pin to go active.
BIT 5 MOTOR ENABLE 1
This bit controls the MTR1 disk interface output. A logic "1" in this bit will cause the output pin to go active.
BIT 6 MOTOR ENABLE 2
This bit controls the MTR2 disk interface output. A logic "1" in this bit will cause the output pin to go active.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 23
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 7 MOTOR ENABLE 3
This bit controls the MTR3 disk interface output. A logic "1" in this bit causes the output to go active.
Table 6.2 - Drive Activation Values
DRIVE
0
1
2
3
6.1.4
DOR VALUE
1CH
2DH
4EH
8FH
Tape Drive Register (TDR)
Address 3F3 READ/WRITE
The Tape Drive Register (TDR) is included for 82077 software compatibility and allows the user to assign
tape support to a particular drive during initialization. Any future references to that drive automatically
invokes tape support. The TDR Tape Select bits TDR.[1:0] determine the tape drive number. Table 6.3
illustrates the Tape Select Bit encoding. Note that drive 0 is the boot device and cannot be assigned tape
support. The remaining Tape Drive Register bits TDR.[7:2] are tristated when read. The TDR is
unaffected by a software reset.
Table 6.3 - Tape Select Bits
TAPE SEL1
(TDR.1)
0
0
1
1
TAPE SEL0
(TDR.0)
0
1
0
1
DRIVE
SELECTED
None
1
2
3
Table 6.4 - Internal 2 Drive Decode - Normal
DRIVE SELECT OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
Bit 7
X
X
X
1
0
Bit 6
X
X
1
X
0
SMSC FDC37C672
Bit 5
X
1
X
X
0
Bit 4
1
X
X
X
0
Bit1
0
0
1
1
X
Bit 0
0
1
0
1
X
nDS1
1
0
1
1
1
Page 24
DATASHEET
nDS0
0
1
1
1
1
MOTOR ON OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
nMTR1
nMTR0
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 6.5 - Internal 2 Drive Decode - Drives 0 and 1 Swapped
DRIVE SELECT OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
Bit 7
X
X
X
1
0
Bit 6
X
X
1
X
0
Bit 5
X
1
X
X
0
Bit 4
1
X
X
X
0
Bit1
0
0
1
1
X
Bit 0
0
1
0
1
X
nDS1
0
1
1
1
1
nDS0
1
0
1
1
1
MOTOR ON OUTPUTS
(ACTIVE LOW)
nMTR1
nMTR0
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
nBIT 4
nBIT 5
Normal Floppy Mode
Normal mode. Register 3F3 contains only bits 0 and 1. When this register is read, bits 2 - 7 are a high
impedance.
REG 3F3
DB7
Tri-state
DB6
Tri-state
DB5
Tri-state
DB4
Tri-state
DB3
Tri-state
DB2
Tri-state
DB1
tape sel1
DB0
tape sel0
DB1
tape sel1
DB0
tape sel0
Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 (OS2)
Register 3F3 for Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 operation.
REG 3F3
DB7
Media
ID1
DB6
Media
ID0
DB5
DB4
Drive Type ID
DB3
DB2
Floppy Boot Drive
For this mode, MEDIA_ID[1:0] pins are gated into bits 6 and 7 of the 3F3 register. These two bits are not
affected by a hard or soft reset.
BIT 7 MEDIA ID 1 READ ONLY (Pin 19) (See Table 6.6)
BIT 6 MEDIA ID 0 READ ONLY (Pin 20) (See Table 6.7)
BITS 5 and 4 Drive Type ID - These bits reflect two of the bits of L0-CRF1. Which two bits these are
depends on the last drive selected in the Digital Output Register (3F2). (See Table 6.8)
BITS 3 and 2 Floppy Boot Drive - These bits reflect the value of L0-CRF1. Bit 3 = L0-CRF1-B7. Bit 2 =
L0-CRF1-B6.
Bits 1 and 0 - Tape Drive Select (READ/WRITE). Same as in Normal and Enhanced Floppy Mode 1.
Note:
L0-CRF1-B5 = Logical Device 0, Configuration Register F1, Bit 5
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 25
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 6.6 - Media ID1
MEDIA ID1
BIT 7
L0-CRF1-B5 L0-CRF1-B5
=0
=1
0
1
1
0
INPUT
Pin 19
0
1
Table 6.7 - Media ID0
MEDIA ID0
BIT 6
CRF1-B4
CRF1-B4
=0
=1
0
1
1
0
INPUT
Pin 20
0
1
Table 6.8 - Drive Type ID
DIGITAL OUTPUT REGISTER
REGISTER 3F3 - DRIVE TYPE ID
Bit 1
Bit 0
Bit 5
Bit 4
0
0
L0-CRF2 - B1
L0-CRF2 - B0
0
1
L0-CRF2 - B3
L0-CRF2 - B2
1
0
L0-CRF2 - B5
L0-CRF2 - B4
1
1
L0-CRF2 - B7
L0-CRF2 - B6
Note:
L0-CRF2-Bx = Logical Device 0, Configuration Register F2, Bit x.
6.1.5
Data Rate Select Register (DSR)
Address 3F4 WRITE ONLY
This register is write only. It is used to program the data rate, amount of write precompensation, power
down status, and software reset. The data rate is programmed using the Configuration Control Register
(CCR) not the DSR, for PC/AT and PS/2 Model 30 and Microchannel applications. Other applications can
set the data rate in the DSR. The data rate of the floppy controller is the most recent write of either the
DSR or CCR. The DSR is unaffected by a software reset. A hardware reset will set the DSR to 02H, which
corresponds to the default precompensation setting and 250 Kbps.
RESET
COND.
SMSC FDC37C672
7
6
S/W
POWER
RESET DOWN
0
0
5
0
0
4
PRECOMP2
0
3
PRECOMP1
0
Page 26
DATASHEET
2
1
0
PREDRATE DRATE
COMP0 SEL1
SEL0
0
1
0
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy controller. See Table 6.10 for the settings corresponding to
the individual data rates. The data rate select bits are unaffected by a software reset, and are set to 250
Kbps after a hardware reset.
BIT 2 through 4 PRECOMPENSATION SELECT
These three bits select the value of write precompensation that will be applied to the WDATA output
signal. Table 6.9 shows the precompensation values for the combination of these bits settings. Track 0 is
the default starting track number to start precompensation. this starting track number can be changed by
the configure command.
BIT 5 UNDEFINED
Should be written as a logic "0".
BIT 6 LOW POWER
A logic "1" written to this bit will put the floppy controller into manual low power mode. The floppy
controller clock and data mode after a software reset or access to the Data Register or Main Status
Register.
BIT 7 SOFTWARE RESET
This active high bit has the same function as the DOR RESET (DOR bit 2) except that this bit is self
clearing.
Note:
The DSR is Shadowed in the Floppy Data Rate Select Shadow Register, LD8:CRC2[7:0]. separator
circuits will be turned off. The controller will come out of manual low power
Table 6.9 - Precompensation Delays
Note:
PRECOMP
432
PRECOMPENSATION
DELAY (NSEC)
111
001
010
011
100
101
110
000
<2MBPS
2MBPS*
0
0.00
20.8
41.67
41.7
83.34
62.5
125.00
83.3
166.67
104.2
208.33
125
250.00
Default
Default
Default: See Table 6.11
*2Mbps data rate is only available if VCC = 5V.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 27
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 6.10 - Data Rates
DRIVE RATE
DRT1
DRT0
DATA RATE
SEL1 SEL0
DATA RATE
MFM
FM
DENSEL
DRATE(1)
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1Meg
500
300
250
--250
150
125
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1Meg
500
500
250
--250
250
125
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1Meg
500
2Meg
250
--250
--125
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
Drive Rate Table (Recommended) 00 = 360K, 1.2M, 720K, 1.44M and 2.88M Vertical Format
01 = 3-Mode Drive
10 = 2 Meg Tape
Note 1:
The DRATE and DENSEL values are mapped onto the DRVDEN pins.
Table 6.11 - DRVDEN Mapping
0
DRVDEN1
(1)
DRATE0
DRVDEN0
(1)
DENSEL
0
1
1
DRATE0
DRATE0
DRATE1
DRATE1
nDENSEL
DRATE0
DT1
DT0
0
1
0
1
DRIVE TYPE
4/2/1 MB 3.5"
2/1 MB 5.25" FDDS
2/1.6/1 MB 3.5" (3-MODE)
PS/2
Table 6.12 - Default Precompensation Delays
DATA RATE
2 Mbps
(Note 6.1)
1 Mbps
500 Kbps
300 Kbps
250 Kbps
PRECOMPENSATION
DELAYS
20.8 ns
41.67 ns
125 ns
125 ns
125 ns
Note 6.1 The 2Mbps data rate is only available if VCC = 5V.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 28
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.6
Main Status Register
Address 3F4 READ ONLY
The Main Status Register is a read-only register and indicates the status of the disk controller. The Main
Status Register can be read at any time. The MSR indicates when the disk controller is ready to receive
data via the Data Register. It should be read before each byte transferring to or from the data register
except in DMA mode. No delay is required when reading the MSR after a data transfer.
7
RQM
6
DIO
5
NON
DMA
4
CMD
BUSY
3
DRV3
BUSY
2
DRV2
BUSY
1
DRV1
BUSY
0
DRV0
BUSY
BIT 0 - 3 DRV x BUSY
These bits are set to 1s when a drive is in the seek portion of a command, including implied and
overlapped seeks and recalibrates.
BIT 4 COMMAND BUSY
This bit is set to a 1 when a command is in progress. This bit will go active after the command byte has
been accepted and goes inactive at the end of the results phase. If there is no result phase (Seek,
Recalibrate commands), this bit is returned to a 0 after the last command byte.
BIT 5 NON-DMA
This mode is selected in the SPECIFY command and will be set to a 1 during the execution phase of a
command. This is for polled data transfers and helps differentiate between the data transfer phase and
the reading of result bytes.
BIT 6 DIO
Indicates the direction of a data transfer once a RQM is set. A 1 indicates a read and a 0 indicates a write
is required.
BIT 7 RQM
Indicates that the host can transfer data if set to a 1. No access is permitted if set to a 0.
6.1.7
Data Register (FIFO)
Address 3F5 READ/WRITE
All command parameter information, disk data and result status are transferred between the host
processor and the floppy disk controller through the Data Register.
Data transfers are governed by the RQM and DIO bits in the Main Status Register.
The Data Register defaults to FIFO disabled mode after any form of reset. This maintains PC/AT
hardware compatibility. The default values can be changed through the Configure command (enable full
FIFO operation with threshold control). The advantage of the FIFO is that it allows the system a larger
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 29
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
DMA latency without causing a disk error. Table 6.14 gives several examples of the delays with aFIFO.
The data is based upon the following formula:
Threshold # x
1
DATA RATE
x8
- 1.5 µs = DELAY
At the start of a command, the FIFO action is always disabled and command parameters must be sent
based upon the RQM and DIO bit settings. As the command execution phase is entered, the FIFO is
cleared of any data to ensure that invalid data is not transferred.
An overrun or underrun will terminate the current command and the transfer of data. Disk writes will
complete the current sector by generating a 00 pattern and valid CRC. Reads require the host to remove
the remaining data so that the result phase may be entered.
Table 6.14 - FIFO Service Delay
Note:
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING AT
2 Mbps* DATA RATE
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING AT
1 Mbps DATA RATE
FIFO THRESHOLD
EXAMPLES
1 byte
2 bytes
8 bytes
15 bytes
MAXIMUM DELAY TO SERVICING AT
500 Kbps DATA RATE
1 x 4 µs - 1.5 µs = 2.5 µs
2 x 4 µs - 1.5 µs = 6.5 µs
8 x 4 µs - 1.5 µs = 30.5 µs
15 x 4 µs - 1.5 µs = 58.5 µs
1 x 8 µs - 1.5 µs = 6.5 µs
2 x 8 µs - 1.5 µs = 14.5 µs
8 x 8 µs - 1.5 µs = 62.5 µs
15 x 8 µs - 1.5 µs = 118.5 µs
1 x 16 µs - 1.5 µs = 14.5 µs
2 x 16 µs - 1.5 µs = 30.5 µs
8 x 16 µs - 1.5 µs = 126.5 µs
15 x 16 µs - 1.5 µs = 238.5 µs
*The 2 Mbps data rate is only available if VCC = 5V.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 30
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.8
Digital Input Register (DIR)
Address 3F7 READ ONLY
This register is read-only in all modes.
PC-AT Mode
RESET
COND.
7
DSK
CHG
N/A
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
BIT 0 - 6 UNDEFINED
The data bus outputs D0 - 6 will remain in a high impedance state during a read of this register.
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and reflects the opposite value seen on the disk cable or the
value programmed in the Force Disk Change Register (see Configuration Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
PS/2 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
DSK
CHG
N/A
6
1
5
1
4
1
3
1
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2
1
0
DRATE DRATE nHIGH
SEL1
SEL0 nDENS
N/A
N/A
1
BIT 0 nHIGH DENS
This bit is low whenever the 500 Kbps or 1 Mbps data rates are selected, and high when 250 Kbps and
300 Kbps are selected.
BITS 1 - 2 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy controller. See Table 6.10 for the settings corresponding to
the individual data rates. The data rate select bits are unaffected by a software reset, and are set to 250
Kbps after a hardware reset.
BITS 3 - 6 UNDEFINED
Always read as a logic "1"
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and reflects the opposite value seen on the disk cable or the
value programmed in the Force Disk Change Register (see Configuration Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 31
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Model 30 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
DSK
CHG
N/A
6
0
5
0
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
0
DMAEN NOPREC DRATE DRATE
SEL1
SEL0
0
0
1
0
BITS 0 - 1 DATA RATE SELECT
These bits control the data rate of the floppy controller. See Table 6.10 for the settings corresponding to
the individual data rates. The data rate select bits are unaffected by a software reset, and are set to 250
Kbps after a hardware reset.
BIT 2 NOPREC
This bit reflects the value of NOPREC bit set in the CCR register.
BIT 3 DMAEN
This bit reflects the value of DMAEN bit set in the DOR register bit 3.
BITS 4 - 6 UNDEFINED
Always read as a logic "0"
BIT 7 DSKCHG
This bit monitors the pin of the same name and reflects the opposite value seen on the disk cable or the
value programmed in the Force Disk Change Register (see Configuration Register LD8:CRC1[1:0]).
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 32
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.9
Configuration Control Register (CCR)
Address 3F7 WRITE ONLY
PC/AT and PS/2 Modes
RESET
COND.
7
6
5
4
3
2
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
1
0
DRATE DRATE
SEL1
SEL0
1
0
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT 0 and 1
These bits determine the data rate of the floppy controller. See Table 6.10 for the appropriate values.
BIT 2 - 7 RESERVED
Should be set to a logical "0"
PS/2 Model 30 Mode
RESET
COND.
7
6
5
4
3
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2
1
0
NOPREC DRATE DRATE
SEL1
SEL0
N/A
1
0
BIT 0 and 1 DATA RATE SELECT 0 and 1
These bits determine the data rate of the floppy controller. See Table 6.10 for the appropriate values.
BIT 2 NO PRECOMPENSATION
This bit can be set by software, but it has no functionality. It can be read by bit 2 of the DSR when in
Model 30 register mode. Unaffected by software reset.
BIT 3 - 7 RESERVED
Should be set to a logical "0"
Table 6.11 shows the state of the DENSEL pin. The DENSEL pin is set high after a hardware reset and is
unaffected by the DOR and the DSR resets.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 33
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.1.10 Status Register Encoding
During the Result Phase of certain commands, the Data Register contains data bytes that give the status
of the command just executed.
Table 6.15 - Status Register 0
BIT NO.
7,6
IC
NAME
Interrupt Code
5
SE
Seek End
4
EC
Equipment
Check
H
DS1,0
Head Address
Drive Select
3
2
1,0
SYMBOL
DESCRIPTION
00 - Normal termination of command. The specified command
was properly executed and completed without error.
01 - Abnormal termination of command. Command execution
was started, but was not successfully completed.
10 - Invalid command. The requested command could not be
executed.
11 - Abnormal termination caused by Polling.
The FDC completed a Seek, Relative Seek or Recalibrate
command (used during a Sense Interrupt Command).
The TRK0 pin failed to become a "1" after:
1. 80 step pulses in the Recalibrate command.
2. The Relative Seek command caused the FDC to step
outward beyond Track 0.
Unused. This bit is always "0".
The current head address.
The current selected drive.
Table 6.16 - Status Register 1
BIT NO.
7
SYMBOL
EN
NAME
End of Cylinder
6
5
DE
Data Error
4
OR
Overrun/
Underrun
3
2
ND
No Data
1
NW
Not Writable
SMSC FDC37C672
DESCRIPTION
The FDC tried to access a sector beyond the final sector of the
track (255D). Will be set if TC is not issued after Read or Write
Data command.
Unused. This bit is always "0".
The FDC detected a CRC error in either the ID field or the data
field of a sector.
Becomes set if the FDC does not receive CPU or DMA service
within the required time interval, resulting in data overrun or
underrun.
Unused. This bit is always "0".
Any one of the following:
1. Read Data, Read Deleted Data command - the FDC did
not find the specified sector.
2. Read ID command - the FDC cannot read the ID field
without an error.
3. Read A Track command - the FDC cannot find the proper
sector sequence.
WP pin became a "1" while the FDC is executing a Write Data,
Write Deleted Data, or Format A Track command.
Page 34
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT NO.
0
SYMBOL
MA
NAME
Missing
Address Mark
DESCRIPTION
Any one of the following:
1. The FDC did not detect an ID address mark at the
specified track after encountering the index pulse from the
IDX pin twice.
2. The FDC cannot detect a data address mark or a deleted
data address mark on the specified track.
Table 6.17 - Status Register 2
BIT NO.
7
6
SYMBOL
NAME
CM
Control Mark
5
DD
4
WC
Data Error in
Data Field
Wrong Cylinder
3
2
1
BC
Bad Cylinder
0
MD
Missing Data
Address Mark
DESCRIPTION
Unused. This bit is always "0".
Any one of the following:
Read Data command - the FDC encountered a deleted data
address mark.
Read Deleted Data command - the FDC encountered a data
address mark.
The FDC detected a CRC error in the data field.
The track address from the sector ID field is different from the
track address maintained inside the FDC.
Unused. This bit is always "0".
Unused. This bit is always "0".
The track address from the sector ID field is different from the
track address maintained inside the FDC and is equal to FF
hex, which indicates a bad track with a hard error according to
the IBM soft-sectored format.
The FDC cannot detect a data address mark or a deleted data
address mark.
Table 6.18 - Status Register 3
BIT NO.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1,0
SMSC FDC37C672
SYMBOL
NAME
WP
Write Protected
T0
Track 0
HD
DS1,0
Head Address
Drive Select
DESCRIPTION
Unused. This bit is always "0".
Indicates the status of the WP pin.
Unused. This bit is always "1".
Indicates the status of the TRK0 pin.
Unused. This bit is always "1".
Indicates the status of the HDSEL pin.
Indicates the status of the DS1, DS0 pins.
Page 35
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.2
RESET
There are three sources of system reset on the FDC: the RESET pin of the FDC, a reset generated via a
bit in the DOR, and a reset generated via a bit in the DSR. At power on, a Power On Reset initializes the
FDC. All resets take the FDC out of the power down state.
All operations are terminated upon a RESET, and the FDC enters an idle state. A reset while a disk write
is in progress will corrupt the data and CRC.
On exiting the reset state, various internal registers are cleared, including the Configure command
information, and the FDC waits for a new command. Drive polling will start unless disabled by a new
Configure command.
6.2.1
RESET Pin (Hardware Reset)
The RESET pin is a global reset and clears all registers except those programmed by the Specify
command. The DOR reset bit is enabled and must be cleared by the host to exit the reset state.
6.2.2
DOR Reset vs. DSR Reset (Software Reset)
These two resets are functionally the same. Both will reset the FDC core, which affects drive status
information and the FIFO circuits. The DSR reset clears itself automatically while the DOR reset requires
the host to manually clear it. DOR reset has precedence over the DSR reset. The DOR reset is set
automatically upon a pin reset. The user must manually clear this reset bit in the DOR to exit the reset
state.
6.3
Modes of Operation
The FDC has three modes of operation, PC/AT mode, PS/2 mode and Model 30 mode. These are
determined by the state of the IDENT and MFM bits 6 and 5 respectively of CRxx.
6.3.1
PC/AT mode - (IDENT high, MFM a "don't care")
The PC/AT register set is enabled, the DMA enable bit of the DOR becomes valid (FINTR and DRQ can
be hi Z), and TC and DENSEL become active high signals.
6.3.2
PS/2 mode - (IDENT low, MFM high)
This mode supports the PS/2 models 50/60/80 configuration and register set. The DMA bit of the DOR
becomes a "don't care", (FINTR and DRQ are always valid), TC and DENSEL become active low.
6.3.3
Model 30 mode - (IDENT low, MFM low)
This mode supports PS/2 Model 30 configuration and register set. The DMA enable bit of the DOR
becomes valid (FINTR and DRQ can be hi Z), TC is active high and DENSEL is active low.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 36
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.4
DMA Transfers
DMA transfers are enabled with the Specify command and are initiated by the FDC by activating the
FDRQ pin during a data transfer command. The FIFO is enabled directly by asserting nDACK and
addresses need not be valid.
Note that if the DMA controller (i.e. 8237A) is programmed to function in verify mode, a pseudo read is
performed by the FDC based only on nDACK. This mode is only available when the FDC has been
configured into byte mode (FIFO disabled) and is programmed to do a read. With the FIFO enabled, the
FDC can perform the above operation by using the new Verify command; no DMA operation is needed.
The FDC37C672 supports two DMA transfer modes for the FDC: Single Transfer and Burst Transfer. In
the case of the single transfer, the DMA Req goes active at the start of the DMA cycle, and the DMA Req
is deasserted after the nDACK. In the case of the burst transfer, the Req is held active until the last
transfer (independent of nDACK). See timing diagrams for more information.
Burst mode is enabled via Bit[1] of CRF0 in Logical Device 0. Setting Bit[1]=0 enables burst mode; the
default is Bit[1]=1, for non-burst mode.
6.5
Controller Phases
For simplicity, command handling in the FDC can be divided into three phases: Command, Execution, and
Result. Each phase is described in the following sections.
6.5.1
Command Phase
After a reset, the FDC enters the command phase and is ready to accept a command from the host. For
each of the commands, a defined set of command code bytes and parameter bytes has to be written to the
FDC before the command phase is complete. (Please refer to Table 7.1 for the command set
descriptions.) These bytes of data must be transferred in the order prescribed.
Before writing to the FDC, the host must examine the RQM and DIO bits of the Main Status Register.
RQM and DIO must be equal to "1" and "0" respectively before command bytes may be written. RQM is
set false by the FDC after each write cycle until the received byte is processed. The FDC asserts RQM
again to request each parameter byte of the command unless an illegal command condition is detected.
After the last parameter byte is received, RQM remains "0" and the FDC automatically enters the next
phase as defined by the command definition.
The FIFO is disabled during the command phase to provide for the proper handling of the "Invalid
Command" condition.
6.5.2
Execution Phase
All data transfers to or from the FDC occur during the execution phase, which can proceed in DMA or nonDMA mode as indicated in the Specify command.
After a reset, the FIFO is disabled. Each data byte is transferred by an FINT or FDRQ depending on the
DMA mode. The Configure command can enable the FIFO and set the FIFO threshold value.
The following paragraphs detail the operation of the FIFO flow control. In these descriptions, <threshold>
is defined as the number of bytes available to the FDC when service is requested from the host and
ranges from 1 to 16. The parameter FIFOTHR, which the user programs, is one less and ranges from 0 to
15.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 37
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
A low threshold value (i.e. 2) results in longer periods of time between service requests, but requires faster
servicing of the request for both read and write cases. The host reads (writes) from (to) the FIFO until
empty (full), then the transfer request goes inactive. The host must be very responsive to the service
request. This is the desired case for use with a "fast" system.
A high value of threshold (i.e. 12) is used with a "sluggish" system by affording a long latency period after
a service request, but results in more frequent service requests.
Non-DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to the Host
The FINT pin and RQM bits in the Main Status Register are activated when the FIFO contains (16<threshold>) bytes or the last bytes of a full sector have been placed in the FIFO. The FINT pin can be
used for interrupt-driven systems, and RQM can be used for polled systems. The host must respond to
the request by reading data from the FIFO. This process is repeated until the last byte is transferred out of
the FIFO. The FDC will deactivate the FINT pin and RQM bit when the FIFO becomes empty.
Non-DMA Mode - Transfers from the Host to the FIFO
The FINT pin and RQM bit in the Main Status Register are activated upon entering the execution phase of
data transfer commands. The host must respond to the request by writing data into the FIFO. The FINT
pin and RQM bit remain true until the FIFO becomes full. They are set true again when the FIFO has
<threshold> bytes remaining in the FIFO. The FINT pin will also be deactivated if TC and nDACK both go
inactive. The FDC enters the result phase after the last byte is taken by the FDC from the FIFO (i.e. FIFO
empty condition).
DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to the Host
The FDC activates the DDRQ pin when the FIFO contains (16 - <threshold>) bytes, or the last byte of a full
sector transfer has been placed in the FIFO. The DMA controller must respond to the request by reading
data from the FIFO. The FDC will deactivate the DDRQ pin when the FIFO becomes empty. FDRQ goes
inactive after nDACK goes active for the last byte of a data transfer (or on the active edge of nIOR, on the
last byte, if no edge is present on nDACK). A data underrun may occur if FDRQ is not removed in time to
prevent an unwanted cycle.
DMA Mode - Transfers from the Host to the FIFO.
The FDC activates the FDRQ pin when entering the execution phase of the data transfer commands. The
DMA controller must respond by activating the nDACK and nIOW pins and placing data in the FIFO.
FDRQ remains active until the FIFO becomes full. FDRQ is again set true when the FIFO has <threshold>
bytes remaining in the FIFO. The FDC will also deactivate the FDRQ pin when TC becomes true (qualified
by nDACK), indicating that no more data is required. FDRQ goes inactive after nDACK goes active for the
last byte of a data transfer (or on the active edge of nIOW of the last byte, if no edge is present on
nDACK). A data overrun may occur if FDRQ is not removed in time to prevent an unwanted cycle.
6.5.3
Data Transfer Termination
The FDC supports terminal count explicitly through the TC pin and implicitly through the underrun/overrun
and end-of-track (EOT) functions. For full sector transfers, the EOT parameter can define the last sector
to be transferred in a single or multi-sector transfer.
If the last sector to be transferred is a partial sector, the host can stop transferring the data in mid-sector,
and the FDC will continue to complete the sector as if a hardware TC was received. The only difference
between these implicit functions and TC is that they return "abnormal termination" result status. Such
status indications can be ignored if they were expected.
Note that when the host is sending data to the FIFO of the FDC, the internal sector count will be complete
when the FDC reads the last byte from its side of the FIFO. There may be a delay in the removal of the
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 38
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
transfer request signal of up to the time taken for the FDC to read the last 16 bytes from the FIFO. The
host must tolerate this delay.
6.5.4
Result Phase
The generation of FINT determines the beginning of the result phase. For each of the commands, a
defined set of result bytes has to be read from the FDC before the result phase is complete. These bytes
of data must be read out for another command to start.
RQM and DIO must both equal "1" before the result bytes may be read. After all the result bytes have
been read, the RQM and DIO bits switch to "1" and "0" respectively, and the CB bit is cleared, indicating
that the FDC is ready to accept the next command.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 39
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 7
Command Set/Descriptions
Commands can be written whenever the FDC is in the command phase. Each command has a unique set
of needed parameters and status results. The FDC checks to see that the first byte is a valid command
and, if valid, proceeds with the command. If it is invalid, an interrupt is issued. The user sends a Sense
Interrupt Status command which returns an invalid command error. Refer to Table 7.1 for explanations of
the various symbols used. Chapter 8 lists the required parameters and the results associated with each
command that the FDC is capable of performing.
Table 7.1 - Description of Command Symbols
SYMBOL
C
D
D0, D1, D2,
D3
DIR
DS0, DS1
DTL
EC
EFIFO
EIS
EOT
GAP
GPL
H/HDS
HLT
HUT
LOCK
SMSC FDC37C672
NAME
Cylinder Address
Data Pattern
Drive Select 0-3
DESCRIPTION
The currently selected address; 0 to 255.
The pattern to be written in each sector data field during formatting.
Designates which drives are perpendicular drives on the Perpendicular
Mode Command. A "1" indicates a perpendicular drive.
Direction Control
If this bit is 0, then the head will step out from the spindle during a relative
seek. If set to a 1, the head will step in toward the spindle.
DRIVE
DS0
Disk Drive Select
DS1
drive 0
0
0
drive 1
1
0
drive 2
0
1
drive 3
1
1
Special Sector Size By setting N to zero (00), DTL may be used to control the number of bytes
transferred in disk read/write commands. The sector size (N = 0) is set to
128. If the actual sector (on the diskette) is larger than DTL, the remainder
of the actual sector is read but is not passed to the host during read
commands; during write commands, the remainder of the actual sector is
written with all zero bytes. The CRC check code is calculated with the
actual sector. When N is not zero, DTL has no meaning and should be set
to FF HEX.
Enable Count
When this bit is "1" the "DTL" parameter of the Verify command becomes
SC (number of sectors per track).
Enable FIFO
This active low bit when a 0, enables the FIFO. A "1" disables the FIFO
(default).
Enable Implied Seek When set, a seek operation will be performed before executing any read or
write command that requires the C parameter in the command phase. A "0"
disables the implied seek.
End of Track
The final sector number of the current track.
Alters Gap 2 length when using Perpendicular Mode.
Gap Length
The Gap 3 size. (Gap 3 is the space between sectors excluding the VCO
synchronization field).
Head Address
Selected head: 0 or 1 (disk side 0 or 1) as encoded in the sector ID field.
Head Load Time
The time interval that FDC waits after loading the head and before initializing
a read or write operation. Refer to the Specify command for actual delays.
Head Unload Time
The time interval from the end of the execution phase (of a read or write
command) until the head is unloaded. Refer to the Specify command for
actual delays.
Lock defines whether EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK parameters of the
CONFIGURE COMMAND can be reset to their default values by a "software
Reset". (A reset caused by writing to the appropriate bits of either the DSR
or DOR)
Page 40
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
SYMBOL
MFM
MT
NAME
MFM/FM Mode
Selector
Multi-Track Selector
N
Sector Size Code
NCN
New Cylinder
Number
Non-DMA Mode
Flag
ND
OW
Overwrite
PCN
Present Cylinder
Number
Polling Disable
POLL
PRETRK
R
RCN
SC
Precompensation
Start Track Number
Sector Address
Relative Cylinder
Number
Number of Sectors
Per Track
SK
Skip Flag
SRT
Step Rate Interval
SMSC FDC37C672
DESCRIPTION
A one selects the double density (MFM) mode. A zero selects single density
(FM) mode.
When set, this flag selects the multi-track operating mode. In this mode, the
FDC treats a complete cylinder under head 0 and 1 as a single track. The
FDC operates as this expanded track started at the first sector under head 0
and ended at the last sector under head 1. With this flag set, a multitrack
read or write operation will automatically continue to the first sector under
head 1 when the FDC finishes operating on the last sector under head 0.
This specifies the number of bytes in a sector. If this parameter is "00", then
the sector size is 128 bytes. The number of bytes transferred is determined
by the DTL parameter. Otherwise the sector size is (2 raised to the "N'th"
power) times 128. All values up to "07" hex are allowable. "07"h would
equal a sector size of 16k. It is the user's responsibility to not select
combinations that are not possible with the drive.
SECTOR SIZE
N
128 bytes
00
256 bytes
01
512 bytes
02
1024 bytes
03
...
..
The desired cylinder number.
When set to 1, indicates that the FDC is to operate in the non-DMA mode.
In this mode, the host is interrupted for each data transfer. When set to 0,
the FDC operates in DMA mode, interfacing to a DMA controller by means
of the DRQ and nDACK signals.
The bits D0-D3 of the Perpendicular Mode Command can only be modified if
OW is set to 1. OW id defined in the Lock command.
The current position of the head at the completion of Sense Interrupt Status
command.
When set, the internal polling routine is disabled. When clear, polling is
enabled.
Programmable from track 00 to FFH.
The sector number to be read or written. In multi-sector transfers, this
parameter specifies the sector number of the first sector to be read or
written.
Relative cylinder offset from present cylinder as used by the Relative Seek
command.
The number of sectors per track to be initialized by the Format command.
The number of sectors per track to be verified during a Verify command
when EC is set.
When set to 1, sectors containing a deleted data address mark will
automatically be skipped during the execution of Read Data. If Read Deleted
is executed, only sectors with a deleted address mark will be accessed.
When set to "0", the sector is read or written the same as the read and write
commands.
The time interval between step pulses issued by the FDC. Programmable
from 0.5 to 8 milliseconds in increments of 0.5 ms at the 1 Mbit data rate.
Refer to the SPECIFY command for actual delays.
Page 41
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
SYMBOL
ST0
ST1
ST2
ST3
WGATE
SMSC FDC37C672
NAME
Status 0
Status 1
Status 2
Status 3
Write Gate
DESCRIPTION
Registers within the FDC which store status information after a command
has been executed. This status information is available to the host during
the result phase after command execution.
Alters timing of WE to allow for pre-erase loads in perpendicular drives.
Page 42
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 8
PHASE
Command
Instruction Set
R/W
W
W
W
D7
MT
0
W
W
W
W
W
W
Execution
Result
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Execution
Result
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
SMSC FDC37C672
D7
MT
0
READ DATA
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
MFM SK
0
0
1
1
0 Command Codes
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
Sector ID information prior to
──────── C ────────
Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
─────── DTL ───────
Data transfer between the FDD
and system.
Status information after Com─────── ST0 ───────
mand execution.
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
Sector ID information after Com──────── C ────────
mand execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
READ DELETED DATA
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
MFM SK
0
1
1
0
0 Command Codes
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
Sector ID information prior to
──────── C ────────
Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
─────── DTL ───────
Data transfer between the FDD
and system.
Status information after Com─────── ST0 ───────
mand execution.
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
Sector ID information after Com──────── C ────────
mand execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
Page 43
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
W
W
D7
MT
0
W
W
W
W
W
W
Execution
Result
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
D7
MT
0
WRITE DATA
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
REMARKS
MFM
0
0
0
1
0
1 Command Codes
0
0
0
0
HDS DS1 DS0
Sector ID information prior to
──────── C ────────
Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
─────── DTL ───────
Data transfer between the FDD
and system.
Status information after Com─────── ST0 ───────
mand execution.
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
Sector ID information after
──────── C ────────
Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
WRITE DELETED DATA
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MFM
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
──────── C ────────
SMSC FDC37C672
REMARKS
Command Codes
Sector ID information prior
to Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
─────── DTL ───────
Execution
Result
D0
1
DS0
R
─────── ST0 ───────
R
R
R
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
──────── C ────────
R
R
R
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
Page 44
DATASHEET
Data transfer between the
FDD and system.
Status information after
Command execution.
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
W
W
D7
0
0
W
W
W
W
W
W
READ A TRACK
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MFM
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
──────── C ────────
D0
0
DS0
Sector ID information prior
to Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
─────── DTL ───────
Data transfer between the
FDD and system. FDC
reads all of cylinders'
contents from index hole to
EOT.
Status information after
Command execution.
Execution
Result
PHASE
Command
R
─────── ST0 ───────
R
R
R
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
──────── C ────────
R
R
R
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
R/W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
D7
MT
EC
VERIFY
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MFM SK
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
──────── C ────────
SMSC FDC37C672
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
D0
0
DS0
REMARKS
Command Codes
Sector ID information prior
to Command execution.
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
─────── EOT ───────
─────── GPL ───────
────── DTL/SC ──────
Execution
Result
REMARKS
Command Codes
R
─────── ST0 ───────
R
R
R
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
──────── C ────────
R
R
R
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
No data transfer takes
place.
Status information after
Command execution.
Sector ID information after
Command execution.
Page 45
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
Result
PHASE
Command
Execution for
Each Sector
Repeat:
Result
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
R
R/W
W
W
W
W
W
W
D7
0
1
D7
0
0
D6
0
0
D5
0
0
VERSION
DATA BUS
D4
D3
D2
1
0
0
1
0
0
FORMAT A TRACK
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
MFM
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
──────── N ────────
──────── SC ────────
─────── GPL ───────
──────── D ────────
W
──────── C ────────
W
W
W
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
R
─────── ST0 ───────
R
R
R
R
R
R
─────── ST1 ───────
─────── ST2 ───────
────── Undefined ──────
────── Undefined ──────
────── Undefined ──────
────── Undefined ──────
R/W
W
W
D7
0
0
D1
0
0
D6
0
0
D5
0
0
RECALIBRATE
DATA BUS
D4
D3
D2
D1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
DS1
D0
1
DS0
REMARKS
Command Codes
Input Sector Parameters
FDC formats an entire
cylinder
Status information after
Command execution
D0
1
DS0
REMARKS
Command Codes
Head retracted to Track 0
Interrupt.
R/W
W
R
R
SMSC FDC37C672
REMARKS
Command Code
Enhanced Controller
Bytes/Sector
Sectors/Cylinder
Gap 3
Filler Byte
Execution
PHASE
Command
Result
D0
0
0
D7
0
SENSE INTERRUPT STATUS
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
─────── ST0 ───────
REMARKS
Command Codes
Status information at the end of
each seek operation.
─────── PCN ───────
Page 46
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
PHASE
Command
Result
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
W
W
R/W
W
W
R
R/W
W
W
W
SPECIFY
DATA BUS
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
─── SRT ───
─── HUT ───
────── HLT ──────
ND
D7
0
0
D7
0
0
D6
0
0
D6
0
0
SENSE DRIVE STATUS
DATA BUS
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
─────── ST3 ───────
SEEK
DATA BUS
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
─────── NCN ───────
REMARKS
Command Codes
D0
0
DS0
Status information about
FDD
D0
1
DS0
Execution
PHASE
Command
SMSC FDC37C672
REMARKS
Command Codes
Head positioned over proper
cylinder on diskette.
Execution
PHASE
Command
REMARKS
Command Codes
R/W
W
W
W
W
R/W
W
W
W
D7
0
0
0
D7
1
0
D6
0
0
EIS
D6
DIR
0
CONFIGURE
DATA BUS
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
EFIFO
POLL
─── FIFOTHR ───
───────── PRETRK ─────────
RELATIVE SEEK
DATA BUS
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
HDS
DS1
─────── RCN ───────
D0
1
DS0
Page 47
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
REMARKS
Configure Information
REMARKS
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
Execution
Result
PHASE
Command
R/W
W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
W
W
D7
0
D6
0
D5
0
DUMPREG
DATA BUS
D4
D3
0
1
D2
1
D0
0
REMARKS
*Note:
Registers
placed in
FIFO
────── PCN-Drive 0 ───────
────── PCN-Drive 1 ───────
────── PCN-Drive 2 ───────
────── PCN-Drive 3 ───────
──── SRT ────
─── HUT ───
─────── HLT ───────
ND
─────── SC/EOT ───────
LOCK
0
D3
D2
D1
D0
GAP
WGATE
0
EIS EFIFO
POLL
── FIFOTHR ──
──────── PRETRK ────────
D7
0
0
D6
MFM
0
D5
0
0
READ ID
DATA BUS
D4
D3
D2
0
1
0
0
0
HDS
D1
1
DS1
Execution
Result
D1
1
R
──────── ST0 ────────
D0
0
DS0
REMARKS
Commands
The first correct ID
information on the Cylinder
is stored in Data Register
Status information after
Command execution.
Disk status after the
Command has completed
R
R
R
R
R
R
PHASE
Command
SMSC FDC37C672
R/W
W
──────── ST1 ────────
──────── ST2 ────────
──────── C ────────
──────── H ────────
──────── R ────────
──────── N ────────
D7
0
OW
D6
0
0
PERPENDICULAR MODE
DATA BUS
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
0
1
0
0
1
D3
D2
D1
D0
GAP
Page 48
DATASHEET
D0
0
WGATE
REMARKS
Command Codes
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PHASE
Command
Result
R/W
W
D7
INVALID CODES
DATA BUS
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
───── Invalid Codes ─────
R
PHASE
Command
Result
R/W
W
R
D0
─────── ST0 ───────
D7
LOCK
0
D6
0
0
D5
0
0
LOCK
DATA BUS
D4
D3
1
0
LOCK
0
D2
1
0
REMARKS
Invalid Command Codes (NoOp FDC goes into Standby State)
ST0 = 80H
D1
0
0
D0
0
0
REMARKS
Command Codes
SC is returned if the last command that was issued was the Format command. EOT is returned if the last
command was a Read or Write.
Note:
These bits are used internally only. They are not reflected in the Drive Select pins. It is the user's
responsibility to maintain correspondence between these bits and the Drive Select pins (DOR).
8.1
Data Transfer Commands
All of the Read Data, Write Data and Verify type commands use the same parameter bytes and return the
same results information, the only difference being the coding of bits 0-4 in the first byte.
An implied seek will be executed if the feature was enabled by the Configure command. This seek is
completely transparent to the user. The Drive Busy bit for the drive will go active in the Main Status
Register during the seek portion of the command. If the seek portion fails, it is reflected in the results
status normally returned for a Read/Write Data command. Status Register 0 (ST0) would contain the error
code and C would contain the cylinder on which the seek failed.
8.1.1
Read Data
A set of nine (9) bytes is required to place the FDC in the Read Data Mode. After the Read Data
command has been issued, the FDC loads the head (if it is in the unloaded state), waits the specified head
settling time (defined in the Specify command), and begins reading ID Address Marks and ID fields. When
the sector address read off the diskette matches with the sector address specified in the command, the
FDC reads the sector's data field and transfers the data to the FIFO.
After completion of the read operation from the current sector, the sector address is incremented by one
and the data from the next logical sector is read and output via the FIFO. This continuous read function is
called "Multi-Sector Read Operation". Upon receipt of TC, or an implied TC (FIFO overrun/underrun), the
FDC stops sending data but will continue to read data from the current sector, check the CRC bytes, and
at the end of the sector, terminate the Read Data Command.
N determines the number of bytes per sector (see Table 8.1 below). If N is set to zero, the sector size is
set to 128. The DTL value determines the number of bytes to be transferred. If DTL is less than 128, the
FDC transfers the specified number of bytes to the host. For reads, it continues to read the entire 128byte sector and checks for CRC errors. For writes, it completes the 128-byte sector by filling in zeros. If N
is not set to 00 Hex, DTL should be set to FF Hex and has no impact on the number of bytes transferred.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 49
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 8.1 - Sector Sizes
N
00
01
02
03
..
07
SECTOR SIZE
128 bytes
256 bytes
512 bytes
1024 bytes
...
16 Kbytes
The amount of data which can be handled with a single command to the FDC depends upon MT (multitrack) and N (number of bytes/sector).
The Multi-Track function (MT) allows the FDC to read data from both sides of the diskette. For a particular
cylinder, data will be transferred starting at Sector 1, Side 0 and completing the last sector of the same
track at Side 1.
If the host terminates a read or write operation in the FDC, the ID information in the result phase is
dependent upon the state of the MT bit and EOT byte. Refer to Table 8.2.
At the completion of the Read Data command, the head is not unloaded until after the Head Unload Time
Interval (specified in the Specify command) has elapsed. If the host issues another command before the
head unloads, then the head settling time may be saved between subsequent reads.
If the FDC detects a pulse on the nINDEX pin twice without finding the specified sector (meaning that the
diskette's index hole passes through index detect logic in the drive twice), the FDC sets the IC code in
Status Register 0 to "01" indicating abnormal termination, sets the ND bit in Status Register 1 to "1"
indicating a sector not found, and terminates the Read Data Command.
After reading the ID and Data Fields in each sector, the FDC checks the CRC bytes. If a CRC error occurs
in the ID or data field, the FDC sets the IC code in Status Register 0 to "01" indicating abnormal
termination, sets the DE bit flag in Status Register 1 to "1", sets the DD bit in Status Register 2 to "1" if
CRC is incorrect in the ID field, and terminates the Read Data Command. Table 8.3 describes the effect
of the SK bit on the Read Data command execution and results. Except where noted in Table 8.3, the C or
R value of the sector address is automatically incremented (see Table 8.5).
Table 8.2 - Effects of MT and N Bits
SMSC FDC37C672
MT
N
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
2
2
3
3
MAXIMUM TRANSFER
CAPACITY
256 x 26 = 6,656
256 x 52 = 13,312
512 x 15 = 7,680
512 x 30 = 15,360
1024 x 8 = 8,192
1024 x 16 = 16,384
FINAL SECTOR READ
FROM DISK
26 at side 0 or 1
26 at side 1
15 at side 0 or 1
15 at side 1
8 at side 0 or 1
16 at side 1
Page 50
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 8.3 - Skip Bit vs Read Data Command
SK BIT
VALUE
DATA ADDRESS
MARK TYPE
ENCOUNTERED
RESULTS
SECTOR READ?
CM BIT OF ST2 SET?
0
Normal Data
Yes
No
0
Deleted Data
Yes
Yes
1
Normal Data
Yes
No
1
Deleted Data
No
Yes
8.1.2
DESCRIPTION OF
RESULTS
Normal termination.
Address not
incremented. Next sector
not searched for.
Normal termination.
Normal termination.
Sector not read
("skipped").
Read Deleted Data
This command is the same as the Read Data command, only it operates on sectors that contain a Deleted
Data Address Mark at the beginning of a Data Field.
Table 8.4 describes the effect of the SK bit on the Read Deleted Data command execution and results.
Except where noted in Table 8.4, the C or R value of the sector address is automatically incremented (see
Table 8.5).
Table 8.4 - Skip Bit vs. Read Deleted Data Command
SK BIT
VALUE
DATA ADDRESS
MARK TYPE
ENCOUNTERED
RESULTS
0
Normal Data
Yes
Yes
DESCRIPTION OF
RESULTS
Address not
incremented. Next sector
not searched for.
0
Deleted Data
Yes
No
Normal termination.
1
Normal Data
No
Yes
Normal termination.
Sector not read
("skipped").
1
Deleted Data
Yes
No
Normal termination.
8.1.3
SECTOR READ?
CM BIT OF ST2 SET?
Read A Track
This command is similar to the Read Data command except that the entire data field is read continuously
from each of the sectors of a track. Immediately after encountering a pulse on the nINDEX pin, the FDC
starts to read all data fields on the track as continuous blocks of data without regard to logical sector
numbers. If the FDC finds an error in the ID or DATA CRC check bytes, it continues to read data from the
track and sets the appropriate error bits at the end of the command. The FDC compares the ID
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 51
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
information read from each sector with the specified value in the command and sets the ND flag of Status
Register 1 to a "1" if there is no comparison. Multi-track or skip operations are not allowed with this
command. The MT and SK bits (bits D7 and D5 of the first command byte respectively) should always be
set to "0".
This command terminates when the EOT specified number of sectors has not been read. If the FDC does
not find an ID Address Mark on the diskette after the second occurrence of a pulse on the IDX pin, then it
sets the IC code in Status Register 0 to "01" (abnormal termination), sets the MA bit in Status Register 1 to
"1", and terminates the command.
Table 8.5 - Result Phase Table
MT
HEAD
0
0
1
1
0
1
FINAL SECTOR
TRANSFERRED TO
HOST
Less than EOT
Equal to EOT
Less than EOT
Equal to EOT
Less than EOT
Equal to EOT
Less than EOT
Equal to EOT
ID INFORMATION AT RESULT PHASE
C
NC
C+1
NC
C+1
NC
NC
NC
C+1
H
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
LSB
NC
LSB
R
R+1
01
R+1
01
R+1
01
R+1
01
N
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
Notes:
NC: No Change, the same value as the one at the beginning of command execution.
LSB: Least Significant Bit, the LSB of H is complemented.
8.1.4
Write Data
After the Write Data command has been issued, the FDC loads the head (if it is in the unloaded state),
waits the specified head load time if unloaded (defined in the Specify command), and begins reading ID
fields. When the sector address read from the diskette matches the sector address specified in the
command, the FDC reads the data from the host via the FIFO and writes it to the sector's data field.
After writing data into the current sector, the FDC computes the CRC value and writes it into the CRC field
at the end of the sector transfer. The Sector Number stored in "R" is incremented by one, and the FDC
continues writing to the next data field. The FDC continues this "Multi-Sector Write Operation". Upon
receipt of a terminal count signal or if a FIFO over/under run occurs while a data field is being written, then
the remainder of the data field is filled with zeros. The FDC reads the ID field of each sector and checks
the CRC bytes. If it detects a CRC error in one of the ID fields, it sets the IC code in Status Register
0 to "01" (abnormal termination), sets the DE bit of Status Register 1 to "1", and terminates the Write Data
command.
The Write Data command operates in much the same manner as the Read Data command. The following
items are the same. Please refer to the Read Data Command for details:
Transfer Capacity
EN (End of Cylinder) bit
ND (No Data) bit
Head Load, Unload Time Interval
ID information when the host terminates the command
Definition of DTL when N = 0 and when N does not = 0
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 52
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
8.1.5
Write Deleted Data
This command is almost the same as the Write Data command except that a Deleted Data Address Mark
is written at the beginning of the Data Field instead of the normal Data Address Mark. This command is
typically used to mark a bad sector containing an error on the floppy disk.
8.1.6
Verify
The Verify command is used to verify the data stored on a disk. This command acts exactly like a Read
Data command except that no data is transferred to the host. Data is read from the disk and CRC is
computed and checked against the previously-stored value.
Because data is not transferred to the host, TC (pin 89) cannot be used to terminate this command. By
setting the EC bit to "1", an implicit TC will be issued to the FDC. This implicit TC will occur when the SC
value has decremented to 0 (an SC value of 0 will verify 256 sectors). This command can also be
terminated by setting the EC bit to "0" and the EOT value equal to the final sector to be checked. If EC is
set to "0", DTL/SC should be programmed to 0FFH. Refer to Table 8.5 and Table 8.6 for information
concerning the values of MT and EC versus SC and EOT value.
Definitions:
# Sectors Per Side = Number of formatted sectors per each side of the disk.
# Sectors Remaining = Number of formatted sectors left which can be read, including side 1 of the disk if
MT is set to "1".
Table 8.6 - Verify Command Result Phase Table
MT
EC
0
Note:
SC/EOT VALUE
TERMINATION RESULT
0
SC = DTL
EOT ≤ # Sectors Per Side
Success Termination
Result Phase Valid
0
0
SC = DTL
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
0
1
SC ≤ # Sectors Remaining AND
EOT ≤ # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
0
1
SC > # Sectors Remaining OR
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
1
0
SC = DTL
EOT ≤ # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
1
0
SC = DTL
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
1
1
SC ≤ # Sectors Remaining AND
EOT ≤ # Sectors Per Side
Successful Termination
Result Phase Valid
1
1
SC > # Sectors Remaining OR
EOT > # Sectors Per Side
Unsuccessful Termination
Result Phase Invalid
If MT is set to "1" and the SC value is greater than the number of remaining formatted sectors on Side 0,
verifying will continue on Side 1 of the disk.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 53
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
8.1.7
Format A Track
The Format command allows an entire track to be formatted. After a pulse from the IDX pin is detected,
the FDC starts writing data on the disk including gaps, address marks, ID fields, and data fields per the
IBM System 34 or 3740 format (MFM or FM respectively). The particular values that will be written to the
gap and data field are controlled by the values programmed into N, SC, GPL, and D which are specified by
the host during the command phase. The data field of the sector is filled with the data byte specified by D.
The ID field for each sector is supplied by the host; that is, four data bytes per sector are needed by the
FDC for C, H, R, and N (cylinder, head, sector number and sector size respectively).
After formatting each sector, the host must send new values for C, H, R and N to the FDC for the next
sector on the track. The R value (sector number) is the only value that must be changed by the host after
each sector is formatted. This allows the disk to be formatted with nonsequential sector addresses
(interleaving). This incrementing and formatting continues for the whole track until the FDC encounters a
pulse on the IDX pin again and it terminates the command.
Table 8.7 contains typical values for gap fields which are dependent upon the size of the sector and the
number of sectors on each track. Actual values can vary due to drive electronics.
Table 8.7 - Format Fields
SYSTEM 34 (DOUBLE DENSITY) FORMAT
GAP4a
80x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IAM
GAP1 SYNC
50x
12x
4E
00
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S N C GAP2 SYNC
E O R
22x
12x
C
C
4E
00
3x FE
A1
3x FC
C2
DATA
AM
C
DATA R GAP3 GAP 4b
C
3x FB
A1 F8
SYSTEM 3740 (SINGLE DENSITY) FORMAT
GAP4a
40x
FF
SYNC
6x
00
IAM
GAP1 SYNC
26x
6x
FF
00
FC
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S N C GAP2 SYNC
E O R
11x
6x
C
C
FF
00
FE
DATA
AM
C
DATA R GAP3 GAP 4b
C
FB or
F8
PERPENDICULAR FORMAT
GAP4a
80x
4E
SYNC
12x
00
IAM
3x FC
C2
SMSC FDC37C672
GAP1 SYNC
50x
12x
4E
00
IDAM
C
Y
L
H
D
S N C GAP2 SYNC
E O R
41x
12x
C
C
4E
00
3x FE
A1
DATA
AM
C
DATA R GAP3 GAP 4b
C
3x FB
A1 F8
Page 54
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 8.8 - Typical Values for Formatting
FORMAT
SECTOR SIZE
N
SC
GPL1
GPL2
FM
128
128
512
1024
2048
4096
...
00
00
02
03
04
05
...
12
10
08
04
02
01
07
10
18
46
C8
C8
09
19
30
87
FF
FF
MFM
256
256
512*
1024
2048
4096
...
01
01
02
03
04
05
...
12
10
09
04
02
01
0A
20
2A
80
C8
C8
0C
32
50
F0
FF
FF
FM
128
256
512
0
1
2
0F
09
05
07
0F
1B
1B
2A
3A
MFM
256
512**
1024
1
2
3
0F
09
05
0E
1B
35
36
54
74
5.25"
Drives
3.5"
Drives
GPL1 = suggested GPL values in Read and Write commands to avoid splice point
between data field and ID field of contiguous sections.
GPL2 = suggested GPL value in Format A Track command.
*PC/AT values (typical)
**PS/2 values (typical). Applies with 1.0 MB and 2.0 MB drives.
Note: All values except sector size are in hex.
8.2
Control Commands
Control commands differ from the other commands in that no data transfer takes place. Three commands
generate an interrupt when complete: Read ID, Recalibrate, and Seek. The other control commands do
not generate an interrupt.
8.2.1
Read ID
The Read ID command is used to find the present position of the recording heads. The FDC stores the
values from the first ID field it is able to read into its registers. If the FDC does not find an ID address mark
on the diskette after the second occurrence of a pulse on the nINDEX pin, it then sets the IC code in
Status Register 0 to "01" (abnormal termination), sets the MA bit in Status Register 1 to "1", and
terminates the command.
The following commands will generate an interrupt upon completion. They do not return any result bytes.
It is highly recommended that control commands be followed by the Sense Interrupt Status command.
Otherwise, valuable interrupt status information will be lost.
8.2.2
Recalibrate
This command causes the read/write head within the FDC to retract to the track 0 position. The FDC
clears the contents of the PCN counter and checks the status of the nTR0 pin from the FDD. As long as
the nTR0 pin is low, the DIR pin remains 0 and step pulses are issued. When the nTR0 pin goes high, the
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 55
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
SE bit in Status Register 0 is set to "1" and the command is terminated. If the nTR0 pin is still low after 79
step pulses have been issued, the FDC sets the SE and the EC bits of Status Register 0 to "1" and
terminates the command. Disks capable of handling more than 80 tracks per side may require more than
one Recalibrate command to return the head back to physical Track 0.
The Recalibrate command does not have a result phase. The Sense Interrupt Status command must be
issued after the Recalibrate command to effectively terminate it and to provide verification of the head
position (PCN). During the command phase of the recalibrate operation, the FDC is in the BUSY state, but
during the execution phase it is in a NON-BUSY state. At this time, another Recalibrate command may be
issued, and in this manner parallel Recalibrate operations may be done on up to four drives at once.
Upon power up, the software must issue a Recalibrate command to properly initialize all drives and the
controller.
8.2.3
Seek
The read/write head within the drive is moved from track to track under the control of the Seek command.
The FDC compares the PCN, which is the current head position, with the NCN and performs the following
operation if there is a difference:
PCN < NCN:
Direction signal to drive set to
"1" (step in) and issues step pulses.
PCN > NCN:
Direction signal to drive set to
"0" (step out) and issues step pulses.
The rate at which step pulses are issued is controlled by SRT (Stepping Rate Time) in the Specify
command. After each step pulse is issued, NCN is compared against PCN, and when NCN = PCN the SE
bit in Status Register 0 is set to "1" and the command is terminated. During the command phase of the
seek or recalibrate operation, the FDC is in the BUSY state, but during the execution phase it is in the
NON-BUSY state. At this time, another Seek or Recalibrate command may be issued, and in this manner,
parallel seek operations may be done on up to four drives at once.
Note that if implied seek is not enabled, the read and write commands should be preceded by:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Seek command - Step to the proper track
Sense Interrupt Status command - Terminate the Seek command
Read ID - Verify head is on proper track
Issue Read/Write command.
The Seek command does not have a result phase. Therefore, it is highly recommended that the Sense
Interrupt Status command be issued after the Seek command to terminate it and to provide verification of
the head position (PCN). The H bit (Head Address) in ST0 will always return to a "0". When exiting
POWERDOWN mode, the FDC clears the PCN value and the status information to zero. Prior to issuing
the POWERDOWN command, it is highly recommended that the user service all pending interrupts
through the Sense Interrupt Status command.
8.2.4
Sense Interrupt Status
An interrupt signal on FINT pin is generated by the FDC for one of the following reasons:
1.
SMSC FDC37C672
Upon entering the Result Phase of:
a. Read Data command
b. Read A Track command
c. Read ID command
d. Read Deleted Data command
e. Write Data command
Page 56
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
2.
3.
f. Format A Track command
g. Write Deleted Data command
h. Verify command
End of Seek, Relative Seek, or Recalibrate command
FDC requires a data transfer during the execution phase in the non-DMA mode
The Sense Interrupt Status command resets the interrupt signal and, via the IC code and SE bit of Status
Register 0, identifies the cause of the interrupt.
Table 8.9 - Interrupt Identification
SE
0
1
IC
11
00
1
01
INTERRUPT DUE TO
Polling
Normal termination of
Seek or Recalibrate
command
Abnormal termination of
Seek or Recalibrate
command
The Seek, Relative Seek, and Recalibrate commands have no result phase. The Sense Interrupt Status
command must be issued immediately after these commands to terminate them and to provide verification
of the head position (PCN). The H (Head Address) bit in ST0 will always return a "0". If a Sense Interrupt
Status is not issued, the drive will continue to be BUSY and may affect the operation of the next command.
8.2.5
Sense Drive Status
Sense Drive Status obtains drive status information. It has not execution phase and goes directly to the
result phase from the command phase. Status Register 3 contains the drive status information.
8.2.6
Specify
The Specify command sets the initial values for each of the three internal times. The HUT (Head Unload
Time) defines the time from the end of the execution phase of one of the read/write commands to the head
unload state. The SRT (Step Rate Time) defines the time interval between adjacent step pulses. Note that
the spacing between the first and second step pulses may be shorter than the remaining step pulses. The
HLT (Head Load Time) defines the time between when the Head Load signal goes high and the read/write
operation starts. The values change with the data rate speed selection and are documented in Table 8.10.
The values are the same for MFM and FM.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 57
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 8.10 - Drive Control Delays (ms)
0
1
..
E
F
2M
64
4
..
56
60
1M
128
8
..
112
120
HUT
500K 300K
426
256
26.7
16
..
..
373
224
400
240
250K
512
32
..
448
480
2M
4
3.75
..
0.5
0.25
1M
8
7.5
..
1
0.5
SRT
500K 300K
26.7
16
25
15
..
..
3.33
2
1.67
1
250K
32
30
..
4
2
HLT
00
01
02
..
7F
7F
2M
64
0.5
1
..
63
63.5
1M
128
1
2
..
126
127
500K
256
2
4
..
252
254
300K
426
3.3
6.7
..
420
423
250K
512
4
8
.
504
508
The choice of DMA or non-DMA operations is made by the ND bit. When this bit is "1", the non-DMA
mode is selected, and when ND is "0", the DMA mode is selected. In DMA mode, data transfers are
signaled by the FDRQ pin. Non-DMA mode uses the RQM bit and the FINT pin to signal data transfers.
8.2.7
Configure
The Configure command is issued to select the special features of the FDC. A Configure command need
not be issued if the default values of the FDC meet the system requirements.
Configure Default Values:
EIS - No Implied Seeks
EFIFO - FIFO Disabled
POLL - Polling Enabled
FIFOTHR - FIFO Threshold Set to 1 Byte
PRETRK - Pre-Compensation Set to Track 0
EIS - Enable Implied Seek. When set to "1", the FDC will perform a Seek operation before executing a
read or write command. Defaults to no implied seek.
EFIFO - A "1" disables the FIFO (default). This means data transfers are asked for on a byte-by-byte
basis. Defaults to "1", FIFO disabled. The threshold defaults to "1".
POLL - Disable polling of the drives. Defaults to "0", polling enabled. When enabled, a single interrupt is
generated after a reset. No polling is performed while the drive head is loaded and the head unload delay
has not expired.
FIFOTHR - The FIFO threshold in the execution phase of read or write commands. This is programmable
from 1 to 16 bytes. Defaults to one byte. A "00" selects one byte; "0F" selects 16 bytes.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 58
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PRETRK - Pre-Compensation Start Track Number. Programmable from track 0 to 255. Defaults to track 0.
A "00" selects track 0; "FF" selects track 255.
8.2.8
Version
The Version command checks to see if the controller is an enhanced type or the older type (765A). A
value of 90 H is returned as the result byte.
8.2.9
Relative Seek
The command is coded the same as for Seek, except for the MSB of the first byte and the DIR bit.
DIR
Head Step Direction Control
DIR
0
1
ACTION
Step Head Out
Step Head In
RCN Relative Cylinder Number that determines how many tracks to step the head in or out from the
current track number.
The Relative Seek command differs from the Seek command in that it steps the head the absolute number
of tracks specified in the command instead of making a comparison against an internal register. The Seek
command is good for drives that support a maximum of 256 tracks. Relative Seeks cannot be overlapped
with other Relative Seeks. Only one Relative Seek can be active at a time. Relative Seeks may be
overlapped with Seeks and Recalibrates. Bit 4 of Status Register 0 (EC) will be set if Relative Seek
attempts to step outward beyond Track 0.
As an example, assume that a floppy drive has 300 useable tracks. The host needs to read track 300 and
the head is on any track (0-255). If a Seek command is issued, the head will stop at track 255. If a
Relative Seek command is issued, the FDC will move the head the specified number of tracks, regardless
of the internal cylinder position register (but will increment the register). If the head was on track 40 (d), the
maximum track that the FDC could position the head on using Relative Seek will be 295 (D), the initial
track + 255 (D). The maximum count that the head can be moved with a single Relative Seek command is
255 (D).
The internal register, PCN, will overflow as the cylinder number crosses track 255 and will contain 39 (D).
The resulting PCN value is thus (RCN + PCN) mod 256. Functionally, the FDC starts counting from 0
again as the track number goes above 255 (D). It is the user's responsibility to compensate FDC functions
(precompensation track number) when accessing tracks greater than 255. The FDC does not keep track
that it is working in an "extended track area" (greater than 255). Any command issued will use the current
PCN value except for the Recalibrate command, which only looks for the TRACK0 signal. Recalibrate will
return an error if the head is farther than 79 due to its limitation of issuing a maximum of 80 step pulses.
The user simply needs to issue a second Recalibrate command. The Seek command and implied seeks
will function correctly within the 44 (D) track (299-255) area of the "extended track area". It is the user's
responsibility not to issue a new track position that will exceed the maximum track that is present in the
extended area.
To return to the standard floppy range (0-255) of tracks, a Relative Seek should be issued to cross the
track 255 boundary.
A Relative Seek can be used instead of the normal Seek, but the host is required to calculate the
difference between the current head location and the new (target) head location. This may require the
host to issue a Read ID command to ensure that the head is physically on the track that software assumes
it to be. Different FDC commands will return different cylinder results which may be difficult to keep track
of with software without the Read ID command.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 59
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
8.2.10 Perpendicular Mode
The Perpendicular Mode command should be issued prior to executing Read/Write/Format commands that
access a disk drive with perpendicular recording capability. With this command, the length of the Gap2
field and VCO enable timing can be altered to accommodate the unique requirements of these drives.
Table 8.11 describes the effects of the WGATE and GAP bits for the Perpendicular Mode command.
Upon a reset, the FDC will default to the conventional mode (WGATE = 0, GAP = 0).
Selection of the 500 Kbps and 1 Mbps perpendicular modes is independent of the actual data rate
selected in the Data Rate Select Register. The user must ensure that these two data rates remain
consistent.
The Gap2 and VCO timing requirements for perpendicular recording type drives are dictated by the design
of the read/write head. In the design of this head, a pre-erase head precedes the normal read/write head
by a distance of 200 micrometers. This works out to about 38 bytes at a 1 Mbps recording density.
Whenever the write head is enabled by the Write Gate signal, the pre-erase head is also activated at the
same time. Thus, when the write head is initially turned on, flux transitions recorded on the media for the
first 38 bytes will not be preconditioned with the pre-erase head since it has not yet been activated. To
accommodate this head activation and deactivation time, the Gap2 field is expanded to a length of 41
bytes. The format field shown in Table 8.7 - Format Fields illustrates the change in the Gap2 field size for
the perpendicular format.
On the read back by the FDC, the controller must begin synchronization at the beginning of the sync field.
For the conventional mode, the internal PLL VCO is enabled (VCOEN) approximately 24 bytes from the
start of the Gap2 field. But, when the controller operates in the 1 Mbps perpendicular mode (WGATE = 1,
GAP = 1), VCOEN goes active after 43 bytes to accommodate the increased Gap2 field size. For both
cases, and approximate two-byte cushion is maintained from the beginning of the sync field for the
purposes of avoiding write splices in the presence of motor speed variation.
For the Write Data case, the FDC activates Write Gate at the beginning of the sync field under the
conventional mode. The controller then writes a new sync field, data address mark, data field, and CRC
as shown on page 57. With the pre-erase head of the perpendicular drive, the write head must be
activated in the Gap2 field to insure a proper write of the new sync field. For the 1 Mbps perpendicular
mode (WGATE = 1, GAP = 1), 38 bytes will be written in the Gap2 space. Since the bit density is
proportional to the data rate, 19 bytes will be written in the Gap2 field for the 500 Kbps perpendicular mode
(WGATE = 1, GAP =0).
It should be noted that none of the alterations in Gap2 size, VCO timing, or Write Gate timing affect normal
program flow. The information provided here is just for background purposes and is not needed for normal
operation. Once the Perpendicular Mode command is invoked, FDC software behavior from the user
standpoint is unchanged.
The perpendicular mode command is enhanced to allow specific drives to be designated Perpendicular
recording drives. This enhancement allows data transfers between Conventional and Perpendicular drives
without having to issue Perpendicular mode commands between the accesses of the different drive types,
nor having to change write pre-compensation values.
When both GAP and WGATE bits of the PERPENDICULAR MODE COMMAND are both programmed to
"0" (Conventional mode), then D0, D1, D2, D3, and D4 can be programmed independently to "1" for that
drive to be set automatically to Perpendicular mode. In this mode the following set of conditions also
apply:
1.
2.
3.
SMSC FDC37C672
The GAP2 written to a perpendicular drive during a write operation will depend upon the programmed
data rate.
The write pre-compensation given to a perpendicular mode drive will be 0ns.
For D0-D3 programmed to "0" for conventional mode drives any data written will be at the currently
programmed write pre-compensation.
Page 60
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Note:
Bits D0-D3 can only be overwritten when OW is programmed as a "1".If either GAP or WGATE is a "1"
then D0-D3 are ignored.
Software and hardware resets have the following effect on the PERPENDICULAR MODE COMMAND:
1.
2.
"Software" resets (via the DOR or DSR registers) will only clear GAP and WGATE bits to "0". D0-D3
are unaffected and retain their previous value.
"Hardware" resets will clear all bits
(GAP, WGATE and D0-D3) to "0", i.e. all conventional mode.
Table 8.11 - Effects of WGATE and GAP Bits
WGATE
0
0
1
1
8.3
GAP
MODE
Conventional
0
Perpendicular
1
(500 Kbps)
Reserved
0
(Conventional)
Perpendicular
1
(1 Mbps)
LENGTH OF
GAP2 FORMAT
FIELD
22 Bytes
22 Bytes
PORTION OF
GAP 2
WRITTEN BY
WRITE DATA
OPERATION
0 Bytes
19 Bytes
22 Bytes
0 Bytes
41 Bytes
38 Bytes
LOCK
In order to protect systems with long DMA latencies against older application software that can disable the
FIFO the LOCK Command has been added. This command should only be used by the FDC routines,
and application software should refrain from using it. If an application calls for the FIFO to be disabled
then the CONFIGURE command should be used.
The LOCK command defines whether the EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK parameters of the
CONFIGURE command can be RESET by the DOR and DSR registers. When the LOCK bit is set to logic
"1" all subsequent "software RESETS by the DOR and DSR registers will not change the previously set
parameters to their default values. All "hardware" RESET from the RESET pin will set the LOCK bit to
logic "0" and return the EFIFO, FIFOTHR, and PRETRK to their default values. A status byte is returned
immediately after issuing a LOCK command. This byte reflects the value of the LOCK bit set by the
command byte.
8.4
Enhanced DUMPREG
The DUMPREG command is designed to support system run-time diagnostics and application software
development and debug. To accommodate the LOCK command and the enhanced PERPENDICULAR
MODE command the eighth byte of the DUMPREG command has been modified to contain the additional
data from these two commands.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 61
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
8.5
Compatibility
The FDC37C672 was designed with software compatibility in mind. It is a fully backwards-compatible
solution with the older generation 765A/B disk controllers. The FDC also implements on-board registers for
compatibility with the PS/2, as well as PC/AT and PC/XT, floppy disk controller subsystems. After a
hardware reset of the FDC, all registers, functions and enhancements default to a PC/AT, PS/2 or PS/2
Model 30 compatible operating mode, depending on how the IDENT and MFM bits are configured by the
system BIOS.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 62
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 9
Serial Port (UART)
The FDC37C672 incorporates two full function UARTs. They are compatible with the NS16450, the 16450
ACE registers and the NS16550A. The UARTS perform serial-to-parallel conversion on received
characters and parallel-to-serial conversion on transmit characters. The data rates are independently
programmable from 460.8K baud down to 50 baud. The character options are programmable for 1 start; 1,
1.5 or 2 stop bits; even, odd, sticky or no parity; and prioritized interrupts. The UARTs each contain a
programmable baud rate generator that is capable of dividing the input clock or crystal by a number from 1
to 65535. The UARTs are also capable of supporting the MIDI data rate. Refer to the Configuration
Registers for information on disabling, power down and changing the base address of the UARTs. The
interrupt from a UART is enabled by programming
OUT2 of that UART to a logic "1". OUT2 being a logic "0" disables that UART's interrupt. The second
UART also supports IrDA, HP-SIR, ASK-IR, Fast IR and Consumer IR infrared modes of operation.
Note:
The UARTs may be configured to share an interrupt.
information.
9.1
Register Description
Refer to the Configuration section for more
Addressing of the accessible registers of the Serial Port is shown below. The base addresses of the serial
ports are defined by the configuration registers (see Configuration section). The Serial Port registers are
located at sequentially increasing addresses above these base addresses. The FDC37C672 contains two
serial ports, each of which contain a register set as described below.
Table 9.1 - Addressing the Serial Port
DLAB
(Note
9.1)
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
A2
A1
A0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
REGISTER NAME
Receive Buffer (read)
Transmit Buffer (write)
Interrupt Enable (read/write)
Interrupt Identification (read)
FIFO Control (write)
Line Control (read/write)
Modem Control (read/write)
Line Status (read/write)
Modem Status (read/write)
Scratchpad (read/write)
Divisor LSB (read/write)
Divisor MSB (read/write
Note 9.1 DLAB is Bit 7 of the Line Control Register
The following section describes the operation of the registers.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 63
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
9.1.1
Receive Buffer Register (RB)
Address Offset = 0H, DLAB = 0, READ ONLY
This register holds the received incoming data byte. Bit 0 is the least significant bit, which is transmitted
and received first. Received data is double buffered; this uses an additional shift register to receive the
serial data stream and convert it to a parallel 8 bit word which is transferred to the Receive Buffer register.
The shift register is not accessible.
9.1.2
Transmit Buffer Register (TB)
Address Offset = 0H, DLAB = 0, WRITE ONLY
This register contains the data byte to be transmitted. The transmit buffer is double buffered, utilizing an
additional shift register (not accessible) to convert the 8 bit data word to a serial format. This shift register
is loaded from the Transmit Buffer when the transmission of the previous byte is complete.
9.1.3
Interrupt Enable Register (IER)
Address Offset = 1H, DLAB = 0, READ/WRITE
The lower four bits of this register control the enables of the five interrupt sources of the Serial Port
interrupt. It is possible to totally disable the interrupt system by resetting bits 0 through 3 of this register.
Similarly, setting the appropriate bits of this register to a high, selected interrupts can be enabled.
Disabling the interrupt system inhibits the Interrupt Identification Register and disables any Serial Port
interrupt out of the FDC37C672. All other system functions operate in their normal manner, including the
Line Status and MODEM Status Registers. The contents of the Interrupt Enable Register are described
below.
Bit 0
This bit enables the Received Data Available Interrupt (and timeout interrupts in the FIFO mode) when set
to logic "1".
Bit 1
This bit enables the Transmitter Holding Register Empty Interrupt when set to logic "1".
Bit 2
This bit enables the Received Line Status Interrupt when set to logic "1". The error sources causing the
interrupt are Overrun, Parity, Framing and Break. The Line Status Register must be read to determine the
source.
Bit 3
This bit enables the MODEM Status Interrupt when set to logic "1". This is caused when one of the
Modem Status Register bits changes state.
Bits 4 through 7
These bits are always logic "0".
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 64
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
9.1.4
FIFO Control Register (FCR)
Address Offset = 2H, DLAB = X, WRITE
This is a write only register at the same location as the IIR. This register is used to enable and clear the
FIFOs, set the RCVR FIFO trigger level.
Note:
DMA is not supported. The UART1 and UART2 FCR’s are shadowed in the UART1 FIFO Control Shadow
Register (LD8:CRC3[7:0]) and UART2 FIFO Control Shadow Register (LD8:CRC4[7:0]).
Bit 0
Setting this bit to a logic "1" enables both the XMIT and RCVR FIFOs. Clearing this bit to a logic "0"
disables both the XMIT and RCVR FIFOs and clears all bytes from both FIFOs. When changing from FIFO
Mode to non-FIFO (16450) mode, data is automatically cleared from the FIFOs. This bit must be a 1 when
other bits in this register are written to or they will not be properly programmed.
Bit 1
Setting this bit to a logic "1" clears all bytes in the RCVR FIFO and resets its counter logic to 0. The shift
register is not cleared. This bit is self-clearing.
Bit 2
Setting this bit to a logic "1" clears all bytes in the XMIT FIFO and resets its counter logic to 0. The shift
register is not cleared. This bit is self-clearing.
Bit 3
Writing to this bit has no effect on the operation of the UART. The RXRDY and TXRDY pins are not
available on this chip.
Bit 4,5
Reserved
Bit 6,7
These bits are used to set the trigger level for the RCVR FIFO interrupt.
9.1.5
Interrupt Identification Register (IIR)
Address Offset = 2H, DLAB = X, READ
BIT 7
BIT 6
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
RCVR FIFO
TRIGGER LEVEL
(BYTES)
1
4
8
14
By accessing this register, the host CPU can determine the highest priority interrupt and its source. Four
levels of priority interrupt exist. They are in descending order of priority:
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 65
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
1.
2.
3.
4.
Receiver Line Status (highest priority)
Received Data Ready
Transmitter Holding Register Empty
MODEM Status (lowest priority)
Information indicating that a prioritized interrupt is pending and the source of that interrupt is stored in the
Interrupt Identification Register (refer to Interrupt Control Table). When the CPU accesses the IIR, the
Serial Port freezes all interrupts and indicates the highest priority pending interrupt to the CPU. During this
CPU access, even if the Serial Port records new interrupts, the current indication does not change until
access is completed. The contents of the IIR are described below.
Bit 0
This bit can be used in either a hardwired prioritized or polled environment to indicate whether an interrupt
is pending. When bit 0 is a logic "0", an interrupt is pending and the contents of the IIR may be used as a
pointer to the appropriate internal service routine. When bit 0 is a logic "1", no interrupt is pending.
Bits 1 and 2
These two bits of the IIR are used to identify the highest priority interrupt pending as indicated by the
Interrupt Control Table.
Bit 3
In non-FIFO mode, this bit is a logic "0". In FIFO mode this bit is set along with bit 2 when a timeout
interrupt is pending.
Bits 4 and 5
These bits of the IIR are always logic "0".
Bits 6 and 7
These two bits are set when the FIFO CONTROL Register bit 0 equals 1.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 66
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 9.2 - Interrupt Control Table
FIFO
MODE
ONLY
INTERRUPT
IDENTIFICATION
REGISTER
INTERRUPT SET AND RESET FUNCTIONS
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
BIT 0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
PRIORITY
LEVEL
Highest
0
1
0
0
Second
1
1
0
0
Second
Character Timeout
Indication
0
0
1
0
Third
Transmitter Holding
Register Empty
0
0
0
0
Fourth
MODEM Status
9.1.6
INTERRUPT
SOURCE
None
None
Receiver Line Status Overrun Error, Parity
Error, Framing Error
or Break Interrupt
Received Data
Receiver Data
Available
Available
INTERRUPT TYPE
INTERRUPT
RESET CONTROL
Reading the Line
Status Register
Read Receiver
Buffer or the FIFO
drops below the
trigger level.
Reading the
Receiver Buffer
Register
No Characters Have
Been Removed
From or Input to the
RCVR FIFO during
the last 4 Char times
and there is at least
1 char in it during
this time
Transmitter Holding Reading the IIR
Register Empty
Register (if Source
of Interrupt) or
Writing the
Transmitter Holding
Register
Clear to Send or
Reading the
Data Set Ready or
MODEM Status
Ring Indicator or
Register
Data Carrier Detect
Line Control Register (LCR)
Address Offset = 3H, DLAB = 0, READ/WRITE
This register contains the format information of the serial line. The bit definitions are:
Bits 0 and 1
These two bits specify the number of bits in each transmitted or received serial character. The encoding of
bits 0 and 1 is as follows:
BIT 1
0
0
1
1
BIT 0
0
1
0
1
WORD LENGTH
5 Bits
6 Bits
7 Bits
8 Bits
The Start, Stop and Parity bits are not included in the word length.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 67
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Bit 2
This bit specifies the number of stop bits in each transmitted or received serial character. The following
table summarizes the information.
Note:
BIT 2
WORD LENGTH
0
1
1
1
1
-5 bits
6 bits
7 bits
8 bits
NUMBER OF
STOP BITS
1
1.5
2
2
2
The receiver will ignore all stop bits beyond the first, regardless of the number used in transmitting.
Bit 3
Parity Enable bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1", a parity bit is generated (transmit data) or checked (receive
data) between the last data word bit and the first stop bit of the serial data. (The parity bit is used to
generate an even or odd number of 1s when the data word bits and the parity bit are summed).
Bit 4
Even Parity Select bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1" and bit 4 is a logic "0", an odd number of logic "1"'s is
transmitted or checked in the data word bits and the parity bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1" and bit 4 is a logic
"1" an even number of bits is transmitted and checked.
Bit 5
Stick Parity bit. When bit 3 is a logic "1" and bit 5 is a logic "1", the parity bit is transmitted and then
detected by the receiver in the opposite state indicated by bit 4.
Bit 6
Set Break Control bit. When bit 6 is a logic "1", the transmit data output (TXD) is forced to the Spacing or
logic "0" state and remains there (until reset by a low level bit 6) regardless of other transmitter activity.
This feature enables the Serial Port to alert a terminal in a communications system.
Bit 7
Divisor Latch Access bit (DLAB). It must be set high (logic "1") to access the Divisor Latches of the Baud
Rate Generator during read or write operations. It must be set low (logic "0") to access the Receiver
Buffer Register, the Transmitter Holding Register, or the Interrupt Enable Register.
9.1.7
Modem Control Register (MCR)
Address Offset = 4H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE
This 8 bit register controls the interface with the MODEM or data set (or device emulating a MODEM). The
contents of the MODEM control register are described below.
Bit 0
This bit controls the Data Terminal Ready (nDTR) output. When bit 0 is set to a logic "1", the nDTR output
is forced to a logic "0". When bit 0 is a logic "0", the nDTR output is forced to a logic "1".
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 68
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Bit 1
This bit controls the Request To Send (nRTS) output. Bit 1 affects the nRTS output in a manner identical
to that described above for bit 0.
Bit 2
This bit controls the Output 1 (OUT1) bit. This bit does not have an output pin and can only be read or
written by the CPU.
Bit 3
Output 2 (OUT2). This bit is used to enable an UART interrupt. When OUT2 is a logic "0", the serial port
interrupt output is forced to a high impedance state - disabled. When OUT2 is a logic "1", the serial port
interrupt outputs are enabled.
Bit 4
This bit provides the loopback feature for diagnostic testing of the Serial Port. When bit 4 is set to logic
"1", the following occur:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
The TXD is set to the Marking State(logic "1").
The receiver Serial Input (RXD) is disconnected.
The output of the Transmitter Shift Register is "looped back" into the Receiver Shift Register input.
All MODEM Control inputs (nCTS, nDSR, nRI and nDCD) are disconnected.
The four MODEM Control outputs (nDTR, nRTS, OUT1 and OUT2) are internally connected to the
four MODEM Control inputs (nDSR, nCTS, RI, DCD).
The Modem Control output pins are forced inactive high.
Data that is transmitted is immediately received.
This feature allows the processor to verify the transmit and receive data paths of the Serial Port. In the
diagnostic mode, the receiver and the transmitter interrupts are fully operational. The MODEM Control
Interrupts are also operational but the interrupts' sources are now the lower four bits of the MODEM
Control Register instead of the MODEM Control inputs. The interrupts are still controlled by the Interrupt
Enable Register.
Bits 5 through 7
These bits are permanently set to logic zero.
9.1.8
Line Status Register (LSR)
Address Offset = 5H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE
Bit 0
Data Ready (DR). It is set to a logic "1" whenever a complete incoming character has been received and
transferred into the Receiver Buffer Register or the FIFO. Bit 0 is reset to a logic "0" by reading all of the
data in the Receive Buffer Register or the FIFO.
Bit 1
Overrun Error (OE). Bit 1 indicates that data in the Receiver Buffer Register was not read before the next
character was transferred into the register, thereby destroying the previous character. In FIFO mode, an
overrun error will occur only when the FIFO is full and the next character has been completely received in
the shift register, the character in the shift register is overwritten but not transferred to the FIFO. The OE
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 69
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
indicator is set to a logic "1" immediately upon detection of an overrun condition, and reset whenever the
Line Status Register is read.
Bit 2
Parity Error (PE). Bit 2 indicates that the received data character does not have the correct even or odd
parity, as selected by the even parity select bit. The PE is set to a logic "1" upon detection of a parity error
and is reset to a logic "0" whenever the Line Status Register is read. In the FIFO mode this error is
associated with the particular character in the FIFO it applies to. This error is indicated when the
associated character is at the top of the FIFO.
Bit 3
Framing Error (FE). Bit 3 indicates that the received character did not have a valid stop bit. Bit 3 is set to
a logic "1" whenever the stop bit following the last data bit or parity bit is detected as a zero bit (Spacing
level). The FE is reset to a logic "0" whenever the Line Status Register is read. In the FIFO mode this
error is associated with the particular character in the FIFO it applies to. This error is indicated when the
associated character is at the top of the FIFO. The Serial Port will try to resynchronize after a framing
error. To do this, it assumes that the framing error was due to the next start bit, so it samples this 'start' bit
twice and then takes in the 'data'.
Bit 4
Break Interrupt (BI). Bit 4 is set to a logic "1" whenever the received data input is held in the Spacing state
(logic "0") for longer than a full word transmission time (that is, the total time of the start bit + data bits +
parity bits + stop bits). The BI is reset after the CPU reads the contents of the Line Status Register. In the
FIFO mode this error is associated with the particular character in the FIFO it applies to. This error is
indicated when the associated character is at the top of the FIFO. When break occurs only one zero
character is loaded into the FIFO. Restarting after a break is received, requires the serial data (RXD) to be
logic "1" for at least 1/2 bit time.
Note:
Bits 1 through 4 are the error conditions that produce a Receiver Line Status Interrupt whenever any of the
corresponding conditions are detected and the interrupt is enabled.
Bit 5
Transmitter Holding Register Empty (THRE). Bit 5 indicates that the Serial Port is ready to accept a new
character for transmission. In addition, this bit causes the Serial Port to issue an interrupt when the
Transmitter Holding Register interrupt enable is set high. The THRE bit is set to a logic "1" when a
character is transferred from the Transmitter Holding Register into the Transmitter Shift Register. The bit is
reset to logic "0" whenever the CPU loads the Transmitter Holding Register. In the FIFO mode this bit is
set when the XMIT FIFO is empty, it is cleared when at least 1 byte is written to the XMIT FIFO. Bit 5 is a
read only bit.
Bit 6
Transmitter Empty (TEMT). Bit 6 is set to a logic "1" whenever the Transmitter Holding Register (THR)
and Transmitter Shift Register (TSR) are both empty. It is reset to logic "0" whenever either the THR or
TSR contains a data character. Bit 6 is a read only bit. In the FIFO mode this bit is set whenever the THR
and TSR are both empty,
Bit 7
This bit is permanently set to logic "0" in the 450 mode. In the FIFO mode, this bit is set to a logic "1"
when there is at least one parity error, framing error or break indication in the FIFO. This bit is cleared
when the LSR is read if there are no subsequent errors in the FIFO.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 70
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
9.1.9
Modem Status Register (MSR)
Address Offset = 6H, DLAB = X, READ/WRITE
This 8 bit register provides the current state of the control lines from the MODEM (or peripheral device). In
addition to this current state information, four bits of the MODEM Status Register (MSR) provide change
information. These bits are set to logic "1" whenever a control input from the MODEM changes state.
They are reset to logic "0" whenever the MODEM Status Register is read.
Bit 0
Delta Clear To Send (DCTS). Bit 0 indicates that the nCTS input to the chip has changed state since the
last time the MSR was read.
Bit 1
Delta Data Set Ready (DDSR). Bit 1 indicates that the nDSR input has changed state since the last time
the MSR was read.
Bit 2
Trailing Edge of Ring Indicator (TERI). Bit 2 indicates that the nRI input has changed from logic "0" to
logic "1".
Bit 3
Delta Data Carrier Detect (DDCD). Bit 3 indicates that the nDCD input to the chip has changed state.
Note:
Whenever bit 0, 1, 2, or 3 is set to a logic "1", a MODEM Status Interrupt is generated.
Bit 4
This bit is the complement of the Clear To Send (nCTS) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic "1", this bit
is equivalent to nRTS in the MCR.
Bit 5
This bit is the complement of the Data Set Ready (nDSR) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic "1", this
bit is equivalent to DTR in the MCR.
Bit 6
This bit is the complement of the Ring Indicator (nRI) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic "1", this bit is
equivalent to OUT1 in the MCR.
Bit 7
This bit is the complement of the Data Carrier
Detect (nDCD) input. If bit 4 of the MCR is set to logic "1", this bit is equivalent to OUT2 in the MCR.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 71
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
9.1.10 Scratchpad Register (SCR)
Address Offset =7H, DLAB =X, READ/WRITE
This 8 bit read/write register has no effect on the operation of the Serial Port.
scratchpad register to be used by the programmer to hold data temporarily.
9.2
It is intended as a
Programmable Baud Rate Generator (and Divisor Latches DLH,
DLL)
The Serial Port contains a programmable Baud Rate Generator that is capable of taking any clock input
(DC to 3 MHz) and dividing it by any divisor from 1 to 65535. This output frequency of the Baud Rate
Generator is 16x the Baud rate. Two 8 bit latches store the divisor in 16 bit binary format. These Divisor
Latches must be loaded during initialization in order to insure desired operation of the Baud Rate
Generator. Upon loading either of the Divisor Latches, a 16 bit Baud counter is immediately loaded. This
prevents long counts on initial load. If a 0 is loaded into the BRG registers the output divides the clock by
the number 3. If a 1 is loaded the output is the inverse of the input oscillator. If a two is loaded the output
is a divide by 2 signal with a 50% duty cycle. If a 3 or greater is loaded the output is low for 2 bits and high
for the remainder of the count. The input clock to the BRG is a 1.8462 MHz clock.
Table 9.3 shows the baud rates possible with a 1.8462 MHz crystal.
9.2.1
Effect Of The Reset on Register File
The Reset Function Table (Table 9.4) details the effect of the Reset input on each of the registers of the
Serial Port.
9.3
FIFO Interrupt Mode Operation
When the RCVR FIFO and receiver interrupts are enabled (FCR bit 0 = "1", IER bit 0 = "1"), RCVR
interrupts occur as follows:
A.
The receive data available interrupt will be issued when the FIFO has reached its programmed trigger
level; it is cleared as soon as the FIFO drops below its programmed trigger level.
B. The IIR receive data available indication also occurs when the FIFO trigger level is reached. It is
cleared when the FIFO drops below the trigger level.
C. The receiver line status interrupt (IIR=06H), has higher priority than the received data available
(IIR=04H) interrupt.
D. The data ready bit (LSR bit 0)is set as soon as a character is transferred from the shift register to the
RCVR FIFO. It is reset when the FIFO is empty.
When RCVR FIFO and receiver interrupts are enabled, RCVR FIFO timeout interrupts occur as follows:
A.
A FIFO timeout interrupt occurs if all the following conditions exist:
At least one character is in the FIFO.
The most recent serial character received was longer than 4 continuous character times ago. (If 2
stop bits are programmed, the second one is included in this time delay).
The most recent CPU read of the FIFO was longer than 4 continuous character times ago.
This will cause a maximum character received to interrupt issued delay of 160 msec at 300 BAUD with a
12 bit character.
B.
SMSC FDC37C672
Character times are calculated by using the RCLK input for a clock signal (this makes the delay
proportional to the baud rate).
Page 72
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
C. When a timeout interrupt has occurred it is cleared and the timer reset when the CPU reads one
character from the RCVR FIFO.
D. When a timeout interrupt has not occurred the timeout timer is reset after a new character is received
or after the CPU reads the RCVR FIFO.
When the XMIT FIFO and transmitter interrupts are enabled (FCR bit 0 = "1", IER bit 1 = "1"), XMIT
interrupts occur as follows:
A.
B.
The transmitter holding register interrupt (02H) occurs when the XMIT FIFO is empty; it is cleared as
soon as the transmitter holding register is written to (1 of 16 characters may be written to the XMIT
FIFO while servicing this interrupt) or the IIR is read.
The transmitter FIFO empty indications will be delayed 1 character time minus the last stop bit time
whenever the following occurs: THRE=1 and there have not been at least two bytes at the same time
in the transmitter FIFO since the last THRE=1. The transmitter interrupt after changing FCR0 will be
immediate, if it is enabled.
Character timeout and RCVR FIFO trigger level interrupts have the same priority as the current received
data available interrupt; XMIT FIFO empty has the same priority as the current transmitter holding register
empty interrupt.
9.4
FIFO Polled Mode Operation
With FCR bit 0 = "1" resetting IER bits 0, 1, 2 or 3 or all to zero puts the UART in the FIFO Polled Mode of
operation. Since the RCVR and XMITTER are controlled separately, either one or both can be in the
polled mode of operation. In this mode, the user's program will check RCVR and XMITTER status via the
LSR. LSR definitions for the FIFO Polled Mode are as follows:
Bit 0=1 as long as there is one byte in the RCVR FIFO.
Bits 1 to 4 specify which error(s) have occurred. Character error status is handled the same way as when
in the interrupt mode, the IIR is not affected since EIR bit 2=0.
Bit 5 indicates when the XMIT FIFO is empty.
Bit 6 indicates that both the XMIT FIFO and shift register are empty.
Bit 7 indicates whether there are any errors in the RCVR FIFO.
There is no trigger level reached or timeout condition indicated in the FIFO Polled Mode, however, the
RCVR and XMIT FIFOs are still fully capable of holding characters.
Table 9.3 - Baud Rates Using 1.8462 MHz Clock for <= 38.4K; Using 1.8432MHz Clock for 115.2k; Using
3.6864MHz Clock for 230.4k; Using 7.3728 MHz Clock for 460.8k
DESIRED
BAUD RATE
DIVISOR USED TO
GENERATE 16X CLOCK
50
75
110
134.5
150
300
600
1200
1800
2304
1536
1047
857
768
384
192
96
64
SMSC FDC37C672
PERCENT ERROR DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
DESIRED AND ACTUAL
(Note 9.2)
0.001
0.004
-
Page 73
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
CRXX:
BIT 7 OR 6
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
DESIRED
BAUD RATE
DIVISOR USED TO
GENERATE 16X CLOCK
2000
2400
3600
4800
7200
9600
19200
38400
57600
115200
230400
460800
58
48
32
24
16
12
6
3
2
1
32770
32769
PERCENT ERROR DIFFERENCE BETWEEN
DESIRED AND ACTUAL
(Note 9.2)
0.005
0.030
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
CRXX:
BIT 7 OR 6
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
Note 9.2 The percentage error for all baud rates, except where indicated otherwise, is 0.2%.
Table 9.4 - Reset Function Table
REGISTER/SIGNAL
Interrupt Enable Register
Interrupt Identification Reg.
FIFO Control
Line Control Reg.
MODEM Control Reg.
Line Status Reg.
MODEM Status Reg.
TXD1, TXD2
INTRPT (RCVR errs)
INTRPT (RCVR Data Ready)
INTRPT (THRE)
OUT2B
RTSB
DTRB
OUT1B
RCVR FIFO
XMIT FIFO
SMSC FDC37C672
RESET CONTROL
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET/Read LSR
RESET/Read RBR
RESET/ReadIIR/Write THR
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET
RESET/
FCR1*FCR0/_FCR0
RESET/
FCR1*FCR0/_FCR0
Page 74
DATASHEET
RESET STATE
All bits low
Bit 0 is high; Bits 1 - 7 low
All bits low
All bits low
All bits low
All bits low except 5, 6 high
Bits 0 - 3 low; Bits 4 - 7 input
High
Low
Low
Low
High
High
High
High
All Bits Low
All Bits Low
Rev. 10-29-03
DLM
MODEM Control Register
Line Status Register
MODEM Status Register
Scratch Register (Note 9.8)
Divisor Latch (LS)
Divisor Latch (MS)
ADDR = 4
ADDR = 5
ADDR = 6
ADDR = 7
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 1
ADDR = 1
DLAB = 1
SMSC FDC37C672
SCR
DDL
Line Control Register
ADDR = 3
Word Length
Select Bit 1
(WLS1)
RCVR FIFO
Reset
Interrupt ID
Bit
Enable
Transmitter
Holding
Register
Empty
Interrupt
(ETHREI)
Data Bit 1
Data Bit 1
BIT 1
Bit 8
Bit 0
Bit 0
Delta Clear to
Send (DCTS)
Data Ready
(DR)
Bit 9
Bit 1
Bit 1
Delta Data
Set Ready
(DDSR)
Overrun
Error (OE)
Data Terminal Request to
Ready (DTR) Send (RTS)
Word Length
Select Bit 0
(WLS0)
FIFO Enable
“0” if Interrupt
Pending
Enable
Received
Data
Available
Interrupt
(ERDAI)
Data Bit 0
Data Bit 0
(Note 9.4)
BIT 0
Bit 10
Trailing
Edge Ring
Indicator
(TERI)
Bit 2
Bit 2
OUT1
(Note 9.6)
Parity Error
(PE)
Number of
Stop Bits
(STB)
XMIT FIFO
Reset
Interrupt ID
Bit
Enable
Receiver
Line Status
Interrupt
(ELSI)
Data Bit 2
Data Bit 2
BIT 2
Rev. 10-29-03
Bit 11
Delta Data
Carrier
Detect
(DDCD)
Bit 3
Bit 3
OUT2
(Note 9.6)
Framing
Error (FE)
DMA Mode
Select
(Note 9.9)
Parity
Enable
(PEN)
Interrupt ID
Bit (Note
9.8)
Enable
MODEM
Status
Interrupt
(EMSI)
Data Bit 3
Data Bit 3
BIT 3
PRELIMINARY DATASHEET
Page 75
MSR
LSR
MCR
LCR
FCR (Note
9.10)
FIFO Control Register (Write Only)
ADDR = 2
IER
Interrupt Enable Register
IIR
THR
Transmitter Holding Register (Write Only)
Interrupt Ident. Register (Read Only)
RBR
REGISTER
SYMBOL
Receive Buffer Register (Read Only)
REGISTER NAME
Table 9.5 - Register Summary for an Individual UART Channel
ADDR = 2
(Note 9.3)
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 0
ADDR = 0
DLAB = 0
ADDR = 1
DLAB = 0
REGISTER
ADDRESS
Datasheet
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Bit 12
Bit 4
Bit 4
Clear to
Send (CTS)
Break
Interrupt
(BI)
Loop
Even Parity
Select
(EPS)
Reserved
0
0
Data Bit 4
Data Bit 4
BIT 4
Bit 13
Bit 5
Bit 5
Data Set
Ready
(DSR)
Transmitter
Holding
Register
(THRE)
0
Stick Parity
Reserved
0
0
Data Bit 5
Data Bit 5
BIT 5
FIFOs
Enabled
(Note 9.8)
0
Data Bit 7
Data Bit 7
BIT 7
Bit 14
Bit 6
Bit 6
Transmitter
Empty
(TEMT)
(Note 9.5)
Ring Indicator
(RI)
0
Set Break
Bit 15
Error in
RCVR
FIFO
(Note 9.8)
Data
Carrier
Detect
(DCD)
Bit 7
Bit 7
Divisor
Latch
Access Bit
(DLAB)
0
RCVR Trigger RCVR
LSB
Trigger
MSB
FIFOs
Enabled
(Note 9.8)
0
Data Bit 6
Data Bit 6
BIT 6
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Note 9.3 DLAB is Bit 7 of the Line Control Register (ADDR = 3).
Note 9.4 Bit 0 is the least significant bit. It is the first bit serially transmitted or received.
Note 9.5 When operating in the XT mode, this bit will be set any time that the transmitter shift register is empty.
Note 9.6 This bit no longer has a pin associated with it.
Note 9.7 When operating in the XT mode, this register is not available.
Note 9.8 These bits are always zero in the non-FIFO mode.
Note 9.9 Writing a one to this bit has no effect. DMA modes are not supported in this chip.
Note 9.10 The UART1 and UART2 FCR’s are shadowed in the UART1 FIFO Control Shadow Register (runtime
register at offset 0x20) and UART2 FIFO Control Shadow Register (runtime register at offset 0x21).
9.5
Notes on Serial Port Operation
9.5.1
FIFO Mode Operation:
GENERAL
The RCVR FIFO will hold up to 16 bytes regardless of which trigger level is selected.
TX AND RX FIFO OPERATION
The Tx portion of the UART transmits data through TXD as soon as the CPU loads a byte into the Tx
FIFO. The UART will prevent loads to the Tx FIFO if it currently holds 16 characters. Loading to the
Tx FIFO will again be enabled as soon as the next character is transferred to the Tx shift register. These
capabilities account for the largely autonomous operation of the Tx.
The UART starts the above operations typically with a Tx interrupt. The chip issues a Tx interrupt
whenever the Tx FIFO is empty and the Tx interrupt is enabled, except in the following instance. Assume
that the Tx FIFO is empty and the CPU starts to load it. When the first byte enters the FIFO the Tx FIFO
empty interrupt will transition from active to inactive. Depending on the execution speed of the service
routine software, the UART may be able to transfer this byte from the FIFO to the shift register before the
CPU loads another byte. If this happens, the Tx FIFO will be empty again and typically the UART's
interrupt line would transition to the active state. This could cause a system with an interrupt control unit to
record a Tx FIFO empty condition, even though the CPU is currently servicing that interrupt. Therefore,
after the first byte has been loaded into the FIFO the UART will wait one serial character
transmission time before issuing a new Tx FIFO empty interrupt. This one character Tx interrupt
delay will remain active until at least two bytes have been loaded into the FIFO, concurrently.
When the Tx FIFO empties after this condition, the Tx interrupt will be activated without a one
character delay.
Rx support functions and operation are quite different from those described for the transmitter. The Rx
FIFO receives data until the number of bytes in the FIFO equals the selected interrupt trigger level. At that
time if Rx interrupts are enabled, the UART will issue an interrupt to the CPU. The Rx FIFO will continue
to store bytes until it holds 16 of them. It will not accept any more data when it is full. Any more data
entering the Rx shift register will set the Overrun Error flag. Normally, the FIFO depth and the
programmable trigger levels will give the CPU ample time to empty the Rx FIFO before an overrun occurs.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 76
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
One side-effect of having a Rx FIFO is that the selected interrupt trigger level may be above the data level
in the FIFO. This could occur when data at the end of the block contains fewer bytes than the trigger level.
No interrupt would be issued to the CPU and the data would remain in the UART. To prevent the
software from having to check for this situation the chip incorporates a timeout interrupt.
The timeout interrupt is activated when there is a least one byte in the Rx FIFO, and neither the CPU nor
the Rx shift register has accessed the Rx FIFO within 4 character times of the last byte. The timeout
interrupt is cleared or reset when the CPU reads the Rx FIFO or another character enters it.
These FIFO related features allow optimization of CPU/UART transactions and are especially useful given
the higher baud rate capability (256 kbaud).
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 77
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 10 Infrared Interface
The infrared interface provides a two-way wireless communications port using infrared as a transmission
medium. Two IR implementations have been provided for the second UART in this chip (logical device 5),
IrDA and Amplitude Shift Keyed IR. The IR transmission can use the standard UART2 TXD2 and RXD2
pins or optional IRTX and IRRX pins. These can be selected through the configuration registers.
IrDA allows serial communication at baud rates up to 4 Mbps. Each word is sent serially beginning with a
zero value start bit. A zero is signaled by sending a single IR pulse at the beginning of the serial bit time.
A one is signaled by sending no IR pulse during the bit time. Please refer to the AC timing for the
parameters of these pulses and the IrDA waveform.
The Amplitude Shift Keyed IR allows serial communication at baud rates up to 19.2K Baud. Each word is
sent serially beginning with a zero value start bit. A zero is signaled by sending a 500KHz waveform for
the duration of the serial bit time. A one is signaled by sending no transmission during the bit time. Please
refer to the AC timing for the parameters of the ASK-IR waveform.
If the Half Duplex option is chosen, there is a time-out when the direction of the transmission is changed.
This time-out starts at the last bit transferred during a transmission and blocks the receiver input until the
timeout expires. If the transmit buffer is loaded with more data before the time-out expires, the timer is
restarted after the new byte is transmitted. If data is loaded into the transmit buffer while a character is
being received, the transmission will not start until the time-out expires after the last receive bit has been
received. If the start bit of another character is received during this time-out, the timer is restarted after the
new character is received. The IR half duplex time-out is programmable via CRF2 in Logical Device 5. This
register allows the time-out to be programmed to any value between 0 and 10msec in 100usec
increments.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 78
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 11 Fast IR
The following is a description of the top level connection for the Fast IR block in the FDC37C672. Refer to
the Infrared Communications Controller Specification for more information on Fast IR.
There are two types of transceiver modules used for Fast IR: one has a mode pin (IR Mode) to control it,
and the other has a second receive data channel (IRRX3). The FDC37C672 has two configuration bits that
can be used for these signals. These are IRMODESEL and IRRX3SEL. The following table illustrates the
selection of the functions.
Table 11.1 - DRVDEN1 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN NAME
IRMODESEL
(LD8:CRC0.0)
IRRX3SEL
(LD8:CRC0.4)
SELECTED
FUNCTION
0
1
1
X
0
1
DRVDEN1 (default)
IRMODE (Note 11.1)
IRRX3
DRVDEN1
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
0
Note 11.1 IRRX3SEL Default (0).
The figure below is the IR interface block diagram.
TXD
TX1
RA
CO
0
TV
RXD
RX1
1
AS
IRT
TX2
IR
0
IrD
RX2
1
IRR
FIR
aux
DRVDE
CO
G.P.
IRMOD
E
1
0
FAST
FAS
T
DRV_DEN
1
IRRX3SE
L
FD
IRMODESE
L
Figure 11.1 - IR Interface Block Diagram
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 79
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 12 Parallel Port
The FDC37C672 incorporates an IBM XT/AT compatible parallel port. This supports the optional PS/2
type bi-directional parallel port (SPP), the Enhanced Parallel Port (EPP) and the Extended Capabilities
Port (ECP) parallel port modes. Refer to the Configuration Registers for information on disabling, power
down, changing the base address of the parallel port, and selecting the mode of operation.
The FDC37C672 also provides a mode for support of the floppy disk controller on the parallel port.
The parallel port also incorporates SMSC's ChiProtect circuitry, which prevents possible damage to the
parallel port due to printer power-up.
The functionality of the Parallel Port is achieved through the use of eight addressable ports, with their
associated registers and control gating. The control and data port are read/write by the CPU, the status
port is read/write in the EPP mode. The address map of the Parallel Port is shown below:
DATA PORT
STATUS PORT
CONTROL PORT
EPP ADDR PORT
BASE ADDRESS + 00H
BASE ADDRESS + 01H
BASE ADDRESS + 02H
BASE ADDRESS + 03H
EPP DATA PORT 0
EPP DATA PORT 1
EPP DATA PORT 2
EPP DATA PORT 3
BASE ADDRESS + 04H
BASE ADDRESS + 05H
BASE ADDRESS + 06H
BASE ADDRESS + 07H
The bit map of these registers is:
D0
PD0
TMOUT
STROBE
PD0
D1
PD1
0
AUTOFD
PD1
D2
PD2
0
nINIT
PD2
D3
PD3
nERR
SLC
PD3
D4
PD4
SLCT
IRQE
PD4
D5
PD5
PE
PCD
PD5
D6
PD6
nACK
0
PD6
D7
PD7
nBUSY
0
AD7
EPP DATA PORT 0
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
EPP DATA PORT 1
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
EPP DATA PORT 2
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
EPP DATA PORT 3
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
DATA PORT
STATUS PORT
CONTROL PORT
EPP ADDR PORT
NOTE
Note 12.1
Note 12.1
Note 12.1
Note 12.2
Note 12.3
Note 12.2
Note 12.3
Note 12.2
Note 12.3
Note 12.2
Note 12.3
Note 12.2
Note 12.3
Note 12.1 These registers are available in all modes.
Note 12.2 These registers are only available in EPP mode.
Note 12.3 For EPP mode, IOCHRDY must be connected to the ISA bus.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 80
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 12.1 - Parallel Port Connector
HOST
CONNECTOR
1
2-9
10
11
12
PIN NUMBER
STANDARD
EPP
nStrobe
PData<0:7>
nAck
Busy
PE
nWrite
PData<0:7>
Intr
nWait
(NU)
13
14
Select
nAutofd
(NU)
nDatastb
15
nError
(NU)
16
nInit
(NU)
17
(1) = Compatible Mode
(3) = High Speed Mode
nSelectin
nAddrstrb
ECP
nStrobe
PData<0:7>
nAck
Busy, PeriphAck(3)
PError,
nAckReverse(3)
Select
nAutoFd,
HostAck(3)
nFault(1)
nPeriphRequest(3)
nInit(1)
nReverseRqst(3)
nSelectIn(1,3)
Note:
For the cable interconnection required for ECP support and the Slave Connector pin numbers, refer to the
IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Standard, Rev. 1.14, July 14, 1993. This
document is available from Microsoft.
12.1
IBM XT/AT Compatible, Bi-Directional and EPP Modes
DATA PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 00H
The Data Port is located at an offset of '00H' from the base address. The data register is cleared at
initialization by RESET. During a WRITE operation, the Data Register latches the contents of the data bus
with the rising edge of the nIOW input. The contents of this register are buffered (non inverting) and output
onto the PD0 - PD7 ports. During a READ operation in SPP mode, PD0 - PD7 ports are buffered (not
latched) and output to the host CPU.
STATUS PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 01H
The Status Port is located at an offset of '01H' from the base address. The contents of this register are
latched for the duration of an nIOR read cycle. The bits of the Status Port are defined as follows:
BIT 0 TMOUT - TIME OUT
This bit is valid in EPP mode only and indicates that a 10 usec time out has occurred on the EPP bus. A
logic O means that no time out error has occurred; a logic 1 means that a time out error has been
detected. This bit is cleared by a RESET. Writing a one to this bit clears the time out status bit. On a
write, this bit is self clearing and does not require a write of a zero. Writing a zero to this bit has no effect.
BITS 1, 2 - are not implemented as register bits, during a read of the Printer Status Register these bits are
a low level.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 81
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 3 nERR - nERROR
The level on the nERROR input is read by the CPU as bit 3 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 0
means an error has been detected; a logic 1 means no error has been detected.
BIT 4 SLCT - PRINTER SELECTED STATUS
The level on the SLCT input is read by the CPU as bit 4 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 1 means
the printer is on line; a logic 0 means it is not selected.
BIT 5 PE - PAPER END
The level on the PE input is read by the CPU as bit 5 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 1 indicates a
paper end; a logic 0 indicates the presence of paper.
BIT 6 nACK - nACKNOWLEDGE
The level on the nACK input is read by the CPU as bit 6 of the Printer Status Register. A logic 0 means
that the printer has received a character and can now accept another. A logic 1 means that it is still
processing the last character or has not received the data.
BIT 7 nBUSY - nBUSY
The complement of the level on the BUSY input is read by the CPU as bit 7 of the Printer Status Register.
A logic 0 in this bit means that the printer is busy and cannot accept a new character. A logic 1 means that
it is ready to accept the next character.
CONTROL PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 02H
The Control Port is located at an offset of '02H' from the base address. The Control Register is initialized
by the RESET input, bits 0 to 5 only being affected; bits 6 and 7 are hard wired low.
BIT 0 STROBE - STROBE
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSTROBE output.
BIT 1 AUTOFD - AUTOFEED
This bit is inverted and output onto the nAUTOFD output. A logic 1 causes the printer to generate a line
feed after each line is printed. A logic 0 means no autofeed.
BIT 2 nINIT - nINITIATE OUTPUT
This bit is output onto the nINIT output without inversion.
BIT 3 SLCTIN - PRINTER SELECT INPUT
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSLCTIN output. A logic 1 on this bit selects the printer; a logic 0
means the printer is not selected.
BIT 4 IRQE - INTERRUPT REQUEST ENABLE
The interrupt request enable bit when set to a high level may be used to enable interrupt requests from the
Parallel Port to the CPU. An interrupt request is generated on the IRQ port by a positive going nACK
input. When the IRQE bit is programmed low the IRQ is disabled.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 82
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 5 PCD - PARALLEL CONTROL DIRECTION
Parallel Control Direction is not valid in printer mode. In printer mode, the direction is always out
regardless of the state of this bit. In bi-directional, EPP or ECP mode, a logic 0 means that the printer port
is in output mode (write); a logic 1 means that the printer port is in input mode (read).
Bits 6 and 7 during a read are a low level, and cannot be written.
EPP ADDRESS PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 03H
The EPP Address Port is located at an offset of '03H' from the base address. The address register is
cleared at initialization by RESET. During a WRITE operation, the contents of DB0-DB7 are buffered (non
inverting) and output onto the PD0 - PD7 ports, the leading edge of nIOW causes an EPP ADDRESS
WRITE cycle to be performed, the trailing edge of IOW latches the data for the duration of the EPP write
cycle. During a READ operation, PD0 - PD7 ports are read, the leading edge of IOR causes an EPP
ADDRESS READ cycle to be performed and the data output to the host CPU, the deassertion of
ADDRSTB latches the PData for the duration of the IOR cycle. This register is only available in EPP
mode.
EPP DATA PORT 0
ADDRESS OFFSET = 04H
The EPP Data Port 0 is located at an offset of '04H' from the base address. The data register is cleared at
initialization by RESET. During a WRITE operation, the contents of DB0-DB7 are buffered (non inverting)
and output onto the PD0 - PD7 ports, the leading edge of nIOW causes an EPP DATA WRITE cycle to be
performed, the trailing edge of IOW latches the data for the duration of the EPP write cycle. During a
READ operation, PD0 - PD7 ports are read, the leading edge of IOR causes an EPP READ cycle to be
performed and the data output to the host CPU, the deassertion of DATASTB latches the PData for the
duration of the IOR cycle. This register is only available in EPP mode.
EPP DATA PORT 1
ADDRESS OFFSET = 05H
The EPP Data Port 1 is located at an offset of '05H' from the base address. Refer to EPP DATA PORT 0
for a description of operation. This register is only available in EPP mode.
EPP DATA PORT 2
ADDRESS OFFSET = 06H
The EPP Data Port 2 is located at an offset of '06H' from the base address. Refer to EPP DATA PORT 0
for a description of operation. This register is only available in EPP mode.
EPP DATA PORT 3
ADDRESS OFFSET = 07H
The EPP Data Port 3 is located at an offset of '07H' from the base address. Refer to EPP DATA PORT 0
for a description of operation. This register is only available in EPP mode.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 83
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
EPP 1.9 OPERATION
When the EPP mode is selected in the configuration register, the standard and bi-directional modes are
also available. If no EPP Read, Write or Address cycle is currently executing, then the PDx bus is in the
standard or bi-directional mode, and all output signals (STROBE, AUTOFD, INIT) are as set by the SPP
Control Port and direction is controlled by PCD of the Control port.
In EPP mode, the system timing is closely coupled to the EPP timing. For this reason, a watchdog timer is
required to prevent system lockup. The timer indicates if more than 10usec have elapsed from the start of
the EPP cycle (nIOR or nIOW asserted) to nWAIT being deasserted (after command). If a time-out
occurs, the current EPP cycle is aborted and the time-out condition is indicated in Status bit 0.
During an EPP cycle, if STROBE is active, it overrides the EPP write signal forcing the PDx bus to always
be in a write mode and the nWRITE signal to always be asserted.
Software Constraints
Before an EPP cycle is executed, the software must ensure that the control register bit PCD is a logic "0"
(i.e. a 04H or 05H should be written to the Control port). If the user leaves PCD as a logic "1", and
attempts to perform an EPP write, the chip is unable to perform the write (because PCD is a logic "1") and
will appear to perform an EPP read on the parallel bus, no error is indicated.
EPP 1.9 Write
The timing for a write operation (address or data) is shown in timing diagram EPP Write Data or Address
cycle. IOCHRDY is driven active low at the start of each EPP write and is released when it has been
determined that the write cycle can complete. The write cycle can complete under the following
circumstances:
1.
2.
If the EPP bus is not ready (nWAIT is active low) when nDATASTB or nADDRSTB goes active then
the write can complete when nWAIT goes inactive high.
If the EPP bus is ready (nWAIT is inactive high) then the chip must wait for it to go active low before
changing the state of nDATASTB, nWRITE or nADDRSTB. The write can complete once nWAIT is
determined inactive.
Write Sequence of operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
The host selects an EPP register, places data on the SData bus and drives nIOW active.
The chip drives IOCHRDY inactive (low).
If WAIT is not asserted, the chip must wait until WAIT is asserted.
The chip places address or data on PData bus, clears PDIR, and asserts nWRITE.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB indicating that PData bus contains valid information, and
the WRITE signal is valid.
Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating that any setup requirements have been satisfied and the chip
may begin the termination phase of the cycle.
a. The chip deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB, this marks the beginning of the termination
phase. If it has not already done so, the peripheral should latch the information byte now.
b. The chip latches the data from the SData bus for the PData bus and asserts (releases) IOCHRDY
allowing the host to complete the write cycle.
Peripheral asserts nWAIT, indicating to the host that any hold time requirements have been satisfied
and acknowledging the termination of the cycle.
Chip may modify nWRITE and nPDATA in preparation for the next cycle.
EPP 1.9 Read
The timing for a read operation (data) is shown in timing diagram EPP Read Data cycle. IOCHRDY is
driven active low at the start of each EPP read and is released when it has been determined that the read
cycle can complete. The read cycle can complete under the following circumstances:
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 84
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
1.
If the EPP bus is not ready (nWAIT is active low) when nDATASTB goes active then the read can
complete when nWAIT goes inactive high.
If the EPP bus is ready (nWAIT is inactive high) then the chip must wait for it to go active low before
changing the state of WRITE or before nDATASTB goes active. The read can complete once nWAIT
is determined inactive.
2.
Read Sequence of Operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The host selects an EPP register and drives nIOR active.
The chip drives IOCHRDY inactive (low).
If WAIT is not asserted, the chip must wait until WAIT is asserted.
The chip tri-states the PData bus and deasserts nWRITE.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB indicating that PData bus is tri-stated, PDIR is set and the
nWRITE signal is valid.
6. Peripheral drives PData bus valid.
7. Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating that PData is valid and the chip may begin the termination
phase of the cycle.
8. a. The chip latches the data from the PData bus for the SData bus and deasserts nDATASTB or
nADDRSTRB. This marks the beginning of the termination phase.
b. The chip drives the valid data onto the SData bus and asserts (releases) IOCHRDY allowing the
host to complete the read cycle.
9. Peripheral tri-states the PData bus and asserts nWAIT, indicating to the host that the PData bus is tristated.
10. Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and nPDATA in preparation for the next cycle.
EPP 1.7 OPERATION
When the EPP 1.7 mode is selected in the configuration register, the standard and bi-directional modes
are also available. If no EPP Read, Write or Address cycle is currently executing, then the PDx bus is in
the standard or bi-directional mode, and all output signals (STROBE, AUTOFD, INIT) are as set by the
SPP Control Port and direction is controlled by PCD of the Control port.
In EPP mode, the system timing is closely coupled to the EPP timing. For this reason, a watchdog timer is
required to prevent system lockup. The timer indicates if more than 10usec have elapsed from the start of
the EPP cycle (nIOR or nIOW asserted) to the end of the cycle nIOR or nIOW deasserted). If a time-out
occurs, the current EPP cycle is aborted and the time-out condition is indicated in Status bit 0.
Software Constraints
Before an EPP cycle is executed, the software must ensure that the control register bits D0, D1 and D3
are set to zero. Also, bit D5 (PCD) is a logic "0" for an EPP write or a logic "1" for and EPP read.
EPP 1.7 Write
The timing for a write operation (address or data) is shown in timing diagram EPP 1.7 Write Data or
Address cycle. IOCHRDY is driven active low when nWAIT is active low during the EPP cycle. This can
be used to extend the cycle time. The write cycle can complete when nWAIT is inactive high.
Write Sequence of Operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The host sets PDIR bit in the control register to a logic "0". This asserts nWRITE.
The host selects an EPP register, places data on the SData bus and drives nIOW active.
The chip places address or data on PData bus.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB indicating that PData bus contains valid information, and
the WRITE signal is valid.
If nWAIT is asserted, IOCHRDY is deasserted until the peripheral deasserts nWAIT or a time-out
occurs.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 85
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
6.
7.
When the host deasserts nIOW the chip deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB and latches the data
from the SData bus for the PData bus.
Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and nPDATA in preparation of the next cycle.
EPP 1.7 Read
The timing for a read operation (data) is shown in timing diagram EPP 1.7 Read Data cycle. IOCHRDY is
driven active low when nWAIT is active low during the EPP cycle. This can be used to extend the cycle
time. The read cycle can complete when nWAIT is inactive high.
Read Sequence of Operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
The host sets PDIR bit in the control register to a logic "1". This deasserts nWRITE and tri-states the
PData bus.
The host selects an EPP register and drives nIOR active.
Chip asserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB indicating that PData bus is tri-stated, PDIR is set and the
nWRITE signal is valid.
If nWAIT is asserted, IOCHRDY is deasserted until the peripheral deasserts nWAIT or a time-out
occurs.
The Peripheral drives PData bus valid.
The Peripheral deasserts nWAIT, indicating that PData is valid and the chip may begin the termination
phase of the cycle.
When the host deasserts nIOR the chip deasserts nDATASTB or nADDRSTRB.
Peripheral tri-states the PData bus.
Chip may modify nWRITE, PDIR and nPDATA in preparation of the next cycle.
Table 12.2 - EPP Pin Descriptions
EPP
SIGNAL
nWRITE
PD<0:7>
INTR
nWrite
Address/Data
Interrupt
WAIT
nWait
I
DATASTB
nData Strobe
O
RESET
nReset
O
ADDRSTB
nAddress Strobe
O
PE
SLCT
Paper End
Printer Selected
Status
Error
Parallel Port
Direction
I
I
nERR
PDIR
SMSC FDC37C672
EPP NAME
TYPE
EPP DESCRIPTION
O
I/O
I
This signal is active low. It denotes a write operation.
Bi-directional EPP byte wide address and data bus.
This signal is active high and positive edge triggered. (Pass through
with no inversion, Same as SPP.)
This signal is active low. It is driven inactive as a positive
acknowledgement from the device that the transfer of data is
completed. It is driven active as an indication that the device is ready
for the next transfer.
This signal is active low. It is used to denote data read or write
operation.
This signal is active low. When driven active, the EPP device is reset
to its initial operational mode.
This signal is active low. It is used to denote address read or write
operation.
Same as SPP mode.
Same as SPP mode.
I
O
Same as SPP mode.
This output shows the direction of the data transfer on the parallel port
bus. A low means an output/write condition and a high means an
input/read condition. This signal is normally a low (output/write)
unless PCD of the control register is set or if an EPP read cycle is in
progress.
Page 86
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Notes:
SPP and EPP can use 1 common register.
nWrite is the only EPP output that can be over-ridden by SPP control port during an EPP cycle. For correct EPP
read cycles, PCD is required to be a low.
12.2
Extended Capabilities Parallel Port
ECP provides a number of advantages, some of which are listed below. The individual features are
explained in greater detail in the remainder of this section.
High performance half-duplex forward and reverse channel
Interlocked handshake, for fast reliable transfer
Optional single byte RLE compression for improved throughput (64:1)
Channel addressing for low-cost peripherals
Maintains link and data layer separation
Permits the use of active output drivers
Permits the use of adaptive signal timing
Peer-to-peer capability
12.2.1 Vocabulary
The following terms are used in this document:
assert:
forward:
reverse:
Pword:
1
0
When a signal asserts it transitions to a "true" state, when a signal deasserts it transitions to a
"false" state.
Host to Peripheral communication.
Peripheral to Host communication
A port word; equal in size to the width of the ISA interface. For this implementation, PWord is
always 8 bits.
A high level.
A low level.
These terms may be considered synonymous:
PeriphClk, nAck
HostAck, nAutoFd
PeriphAck, Busy
nPeriphRequest, nFault
nReverseRequest, nInit
nAckReverse, PError
Xflag, Select
ECPMode, nSelectln
HostClk, nStrobe
Reference Document: IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Interface Standard, Rev
1.14, July 14, 1993. This document is available from Microsoft.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 87
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
The bit map of the Extended Parallel Port registers is:
D7
PD7
Addr/RLE
D6
PD6
dsr
nBusy
nAck
PError
Select
nFault
0
0
0
dcr
0
0
Direction
ackIntEn
SelectIn
nInit
autofd
strobe
data
ecpAFifo
D5
PD5
cFifo
D4
D3
D2
PD4
PD3
PD2
Address or RLE field
D0
PD0
NOTE
Parallel Port Data FIFO
ecpDFifo
ECP Data FIFO
tFifo
cnfgA
cnfgB
ecr
D1
PD1
Test FIFO
0
compress
0
intrValue
MODE
0
1
0
Parallel Port IRQ
nErrIntrEn dmaEn
Note
12.5
Note
12.4
Note
12.4
Note
12.5
Note
12.5
Note
12.5
0
0
0
Parallel Port DMA
serviceIntr
full
empty
Note 12.4 These registers are available in all modes.
Note 12.5 All FIFOs use one common 16 byte FIFO.
Note 12.6 The ECP Parallel Port Config Reg B reflects the IRQ and DRQ selected by the Configuration Registers.
12.3
ISA Implementation Standard
This specification describes the standard ISA interface to the Extended Capabilities Port (ECP). All ISA
devices supporting ECP must meet the requirements contained in this section or the port will not be
supported by Microsoft. For a description of the ECP Protocol, please refer to the IEEE 1284 Extended
Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA Interface Standard, Rev. 1.14, July 14, 1993. This document is
available from Microsoft.
Description
The port is software and hardware compatible with existing parallel ports so that it may be used as a
standard LPT port if ECP is not required. The port is designed to be simple and requires a small number of
gates to implement. It does not do any "protocol" negotiation, rather it provides an automatic high
burst-bandwidth channel that supports DMA for ECP in both the forward and reverse directions.
Small FIFOs are employed in both forward and reverse directions to smooth data flow and improve the
maximum bandwidth requirement. The size of the FIFO is 16 bytes deep. The port supports an automatic
handshake for the standard parallel port to improve compatibility mode transfer speed.
The port also supports run length encoded (RLE) decompression (required) in hardware. Compression is
accomplished by counting identical bytes and transmitting an RLE byte that indicates how many times the
next byte is to be repeated. Decompression simply intercepts the RLE byte and repeats the following byte
the specified number of times. Hardware support for compression is optional.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 88
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 12.3 - ECP Pin Descriptions
NAME
nStrobe
PData 7:0
nAck
TYPE
O
I/O
I
PeriphAck (Busy)
I
PError
(nAckReverse)
I
Select
nAutoFd
(HostAck)
I
O
nFault
(nPeriphRequest)
I
nInit
O
nSelectIn
O
SMSC FDC37C672
DESCRIPTION
During write operations nStrobe registers data or address into the slave on the
asserting edge (handshakes with Busy).
Contains address or data or RLE data.
Indicates valid data driven by the peripheral when asserted. This signal
handshakes with nAutoFd in reverse.
This signal deasserts to indicate that the peripheral can accept data. This signal
handshakes with nStrobe in the forward direction. In the reverse direction this
signal indicates whether the data lines contain ECP command information or data.
The peripheral uses this signal to flow control in the forward direction. It is an
"interlocked" handshake with nStrobe. PeriphAck also provides command
information in the reverse direction.
Used to acknowledge a change in the direction the transfer (asserted = forward).
The peripheral drives this signal low to acknowledge nReverseRequest. It is an
"interlocked" handshake with nReverseRequest. The host relies upon
nAckReverse to determine when it is permitted to drive the data bus.
Indicates printer on line.
Requests a byte of data from the peripheral when asserted, handshaking with
nAck in the reverse direction. In the forward direction this signal indicates whether
the data lines contain ECP address or data. The host drives this signal to flow
control in the reverse direction. It is an "interlocked" handshake with nAck. HostAck
also provides command information in the forward phase.
Generates an error interrupt when asserted. This signal provides a mechanism for
peer-to-peer communication. This signal is valid only in the forward direction.
During ECP Mode the peripheral is permitted (but not required) to drive this pin low
to request a reverse transfer. The request is merely a "hint" to the host; the host
has ultimate control over the transfer direction. This signal would be typically used
to generate an interrupt to the host CPU.
Sets the transfer direction (asserted = reverse, deasserted = forward). This pin is
driven low to place the channel in the reverse direction. The peripheral is only
allowed to drive the bi-directional data bus while in ECP Mode and HostAck is low
and nSelectIn is high.
Always deasserted in ECP mode.
Page 89
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
12.3.1 Register Definitions
The register definitions are based on the standard IBM addresses for LPT. All of the standard printer ports
are supported. The additional registers attach to an upper bit decode of the standard LPT port definition to
avoid conflict with standard ISA devices. The port is equivalent to a generic parallel port interface and may
be operated in that mode. The port registers vary depending on the mode field in the ecr. The table below
lists these dependencies. Operation of the devices in modes other that those specified is undefined.
Table 12.4 - ECP Register Definitions
NAME
data
ecpAFifo
dsr
dcr
cFifo
ecpDFifo
tFifo
cnfgA
cnfgB
ecr
ADDRESS (Note 12.7)
+000h R/W
+000h R/W
+001h R/W
+002h R/W
+400h R/W
+400h R/W
+400h R/W
+400h R
+401h R/W
+402h R/W
ECP MODES
000-001
011
All
All
010
011
110
111
111
All
FUNCTION
Data Register
ECP FIFO (Address)
Status Register
Control Register
Parallel Port Data FIFO
ECP FIFO (DATA)
Test FIFO
Configuration Register A
Configuration Register B
Extended Control Register
Note 12.7 These addresses are added to the parallel port base address as selected by configuration register or
jumpers.
Note 12.8 All addresses are qualified with AEN. Refer to the AEN pin definition.
Table 12.5 - Mode Descriptions
MODE
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
DESCRIPTION (Note 12.9)
SPP mode
PS/2 Parallel Port mode
Parallel Port Data FIFO mode
ECP Parallel Port mode
EPP mode (If this option is enabled in the configuration registers)
(Reserved)
Test mode
Configuration mode
Note 12.9 Refer to ECR Register Description
DATA and ecpAFifo PORT
ADDRESS OFFSET = 00H
Modes 000 and 001 (Data Port)
The Data Port is located at an offset of '00H' from the base address. The data register is cleared at
initialization by RESET. During a WRITE operation, the Data Register latches the contents of the data bus
on the rising edge of the nIOW input. The contents of this register are buffered (non inverting) and output
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 90
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
onto the PD0 - PD7 ports. During a READ operation, PD0 - PD7 ports are read and output to the host
CPU.
Mode 011 (ECP FIFO - Address/RLE)
A data byte written to this address is placed in the FIFO and tagged as an ECP Address/RLE. The
hardware at the ECP port transmits this byte to the peripheral automatically. The operation of this register
is only defined for the forward direction (direction is 0). Refer to the ECP Parallel Port Forward Timing
Diagram, located in the Timing Diagrams section of this data sheet .
DEVICE STATUS REGISTER (dsr)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 01H
The Status Port is located at an offset of '01H' from the base address. Bits 0 - 2 are not implemented as
register bits, during a read of the Printer Status Register these bits are a low level. The bits of the Status
Port are defined as follows:
BIT 3 nFault
The level on the nFault input is read by the CPU as bit 3 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 4 Select
The level on the Select input is read by the CPU as bit 4 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 5 PError
The level on the PError input is read by the CPU as bit 5 of the Device Status Register. Printer Status
Register.
BIT 6 nAck
The level on the nAck input is read by the CPU as bit 6 of the Device Status Register.
BIT 7 nBusy
The complement of the level on the BUSY input is read by the CPU as bit 7 of the Device Status Register.
DEVICE CONTROL REGISTER (dcr)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 02H
The Control Register is located at an offset of '02H' from the base address. The Control Register is
initialized to zero by the RESET input, bits 0 to 5 only being affected; bits 6 and 7 are hard wired low.
BIT 0 STROBE - STROBE
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSTROBE output.
BIT 1 AUTOFD - AUTOFEED
This bit is inverted and output onto the nAUTOFD output. A logic 1 causes the printer to generate a line
feed after each line is printed. A logic 0 means no autofeed.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 91
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 2 nINIT - nINITIATE OUTPUT
This bit is output onto the nINIT output without inversion.
BIT 3 SELECTIN
This bit is inverted and output onto the nSLCTIN output. A logic 1 on this bit selects the printer; a logic 0
means the printer is not selected.
BIT 4 ackIntEn - INTERRUPT REQUEST ENABLE
The interrupt request enable bit when set to a high level may be used to enable interrupt requests from the
Parallel Port to the CPU due to a low to high transition on the nACK input. Refer to the description of the
interrupt under Operation, Interrupts.
BIT 5 DIRECTION
If mode=000 or mode=010, this bit has no effect and the direction is always out regardless of the state of
this bit. In all other modes, Direction is valid and a logic 0 means that the printer port is in output mode
(write); a logic 1 means that the printer port is in input mode (read).
BITS 6 and 7 during a read are a low level, and cannot be written.
cFifo (Parallel Port Data FIFO)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400h
Mode = 010
Bytes written or DMAed from the system to this FIFO are transmitted by a hardware handshake to the
peripheral using the standard parallel port protocol. Transfers to the FIFO are byte aligned. This mode is
only defined for the forward direction.
ecpDFifo (ECP Data FIFO)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 011
Bytes written or DMAed from the system to this FIFO, when the direction bit is 0, are transmitted by a
hardware handshake to the peripheral using the ECP parallel port protocol. Transfers to the FIFO are byte
aligned.
Data bytes from the peripheral are read under automatic hardware handshake from ECP into this FIFO
when the direction bit is 1. Reads or DMAs from the FIFO will return bytes of ECP data to the system.
tFifo (Test FIFO Mode)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 110
Data bytes may be read, written or DMAed to or from the system to this FIFO in any direction. Data in the
tFIFO will not be transmitted to the to the parallel port lines using a hardware protocol handshake.
However, data in the tFIFO may be displayed on the parallel port data lines.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 92
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
The tFIFO will not stall when overwritten or underrun. If an attempt is made to write data to a full tFIFO,
the new data is not accepted into the tFIFO. If an attempt is made to read data from an empty tFIFO, the
last data byte is re-read again. The full and empty bits must always keep track of the correct FIFO state.
The tFIFO will transfer data at the maximum ISA rate so that software may generate performance metrics.
The FIFO size and interrupt threshold can be determined by writing bytes to the FIFO and checking the full
and serviceIntr bits.
The writeIntrThreshold can be determined by starting with a full tFIFO, setting the direction bit to 0 and
emptying it a byte at a time until serviceIntr is set. This may generate a spurious interrupt, but will indicate
that the threshold has been reached.
The readIntrThreshold can be determined by setting the direction bit to 1 and filling the empty tFIFO a byte at
a time until serviceIntr is set. This may generate a spurious interrupt, but will indicate that the threshold has
been reached.
Data bytes are always read from the head of tFIFO regardless of the value of the direction bit. For example if
44h, 33h, 22h is written to the FIFO, then reading the tFIFO will return 44h, 33h, 22h in the same order as
was written.
cnfgA (Configuration Register A)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 400H
Mode = 111
This register is a read only register. When read, 10H is returned. This indicates to the system that this is
an 8-bit implementation. (PWord = 1 byte)
cnfgB (Configuration Register B)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 401H
Mode = 111
BIT 7 compress
This bit is read only. During a read it is a low level. This means that this chip does not support hardware
RLE compression. It does support hardware de-compression!
BIT 6 intrValue
Returns the value on the ISA iRq line to determine possible conflicts.
BITS [3:0] Parallel Port IRQ
Refer to Table 12.6B.
BITS [2:0] Parallel Port DMA
Refer to Table 12.6C.
ecr (Extended Control Register)
ADDRESS OFFSET = 402H
Mode = all
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 93
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
This register controls the extended ECP parallel port functions.
BITS 7,6,5
These bits are Read/Write and select the Mode.
BIT 4 nErrIntrEn
Read/Write (Valid only in ECP Mode)
1:
Disables the interrupt generated on the asserting edge of nFault.
0:
Enables an interrupt pulse on the high to low edge of nFault. Note that an interrupt will be generated if
nFault is asserted (interrupting) and this bit is written from a 1 to a 0. This prevents interrupts from
being lost in the time between the read of the ecr and the write of the ecr.
BIT 3 dmaEn
Read/Write
1:
Enables DMA (DMA starts when serviceIntr is 0).
0:
Disables DMA unconditionally.
BIT 2 serviceIntr
Read/Write
1:
Disables DMA and all of the service interrupts.
0:
Enables one of the following 3 cases of interrupts. Once one of the 3 service interrupts has occurred
serviceIntr bit shall be set to a 1 by hardware. It must be reset to 0 to re-enable the interrupts. Writing
this bit to a 1 will not cause an interrupt.
case dmaEn=1:
During DMA (this bit is set to a 1 when terminal count is reached).
case dmaEn=0 direction=0:
This bit shall be set to 1 whenever there are writeIntrThreshold or more bytes free in the FIFO.
case dmaEn=0 direction=1:
This bit shall be set to 1 whenever there are readIntrThreshold or more valid bytes to be read from the
FIFO.
BIT 1 full
Read only
1:
The FIFO cannot accept another byte or the FIFO is completely full.
0:
The FIFO has at least 1 free byte.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 94
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
BIT 0 empty
Read only
1:
The FIFO is completely empty.
0:
The FIFO contains at least 1 byte of data.
Table 12.6A - Extended Control Register
R/W
MODE
000:
Standard Parallel Port Mode . In this mode the FIFO is reset and common collector drivers are used on the
control lines (nStrobe, nAutoFd, nInit and nSelectIn). Setting the direction bit will not tri-state the output
drivers in this mode.
001:
PS/2 Parallel Port Mode. Same as above except that direction may be used to tri-state the data lines and
reading the data register returns the value on the data lines and not the value in the data register. All
drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
010:
Parallel Port FIFO Mode. This is the same as 000 except that bytes are written or DMAed to the FIFO. FIFO
data is automatically transmitted using the standard parallel port protocol. Note that this mode is only useful
when direction is 0. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
011:
ECP Parallel Port Mode. In the forward direction (direction is 0) bytes placed into the ecpDFifo and bytes
written to the ecpAFifo are placed in a single FIFO and transmitted automatically to the peripheral using
ECP Protocol. In the reverse direction (direction is 1) bytes are moved from the ECP parallel port and
packed into bytes in the ecpDFifo. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
100:
Selects EPP Mode: In this mode, EPP is selected if the EPP supported option is selected in configuration
register L3-CRF0. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
101:
Reserved
110:
Test Mode. In this mode the FIFO may be written and read, but the data will not be transmitted on the
parallel port. All drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
111:
Configuration Mode. In this mode the confgA, confgB registers are accessible at 0x400 and 0x401. All
drivers have active pull-ups (push-pull).
Table 12.6B
CONFIG REG B
IRQ SELECTED
BITS 5:3
15
110
14
101
11
100
10
011
9
010
7
001
5
111
All Others
000
SMSC FDC37C672
Table 12.6C
CONFIG REG B
DMA SELECTED
BITS 2:0
3
011
2
010
1
001
All Others
000
Page 95
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
12.4
Operation
12.4.1 Mode Switching/Software Control
Software will execute P1284 negotiation and all operation prior to a data transfer phase under
programmed I/O control (mode 000 or 001). Hardware provides an automatic control line handshake,
moving data between the FIFO and the ECP port only in the data transfer phase (modes 011 or 010).
Setting the mode to 011 or 010 will cause the hardware to initiate data transfer.
If the port is in mode 000 or 001 it may switch to any other mode. If the port is not in mode 000 or 001 it
can only be switched into mode 000 or 001. The direction can only be changed in mode 001.
Once in an extended forward mode the software should wait for the FIFO to be empty before switching
back to mode 000 or 001. In this case all control signals will be deasserted before the mode switch. In an
ecp reverse mode the software waits for all the data to be read from the FIFO before changing back to
mode 000 or 001. Since the automatic hardware ecp reverse handshake only cares about the state of the
FIFO it may have acquired extra data which will be discarded. It may in fact be in the middle of a transfer
when the mode is changed back to 000 or 001. In this case the port will deassert nAutoFd independent of
the state of the transfer. The design shall not cause glitches on the handshake signals if the software
meets the constraints above.
ECP Operation
Prior to ECP operation the Host must negotiate on the parallel port to determine if the peripheral supports
the ECP protocol. This is a somewhat complex negotiation carried out under program control in mode 000.
After negotiation, it is necessary to initialize some of the port bits. The following are required:
Set
Set
Set
Set
Direction = 0, enabling the drivers.
strobe = 0, causing the nStrobe signal to default to the deasserted state.
autoFd = 0, causing the nAutoFd signal to default to the deasserted state.
mode = 011 (ECP Mode)
ECP address/RLE bytes or data bytes may be sent automatically by writing the ecpAFifo or ecpDFifo
respectively.
Note that all FIFO data transfers are byte wide and byte aligned. Address/RLE transfers are byte-wide
and only allowed in the forward direction.
The host may switch directions by first switching to mode = 001, negotiating for the forward or reverse
channel, setting direction to 1 or 0, then setting mode = 011. When direction is 1 the hardware shall
handshake for each ECP read data byte and attempt to fill the FIFO. Bytes may then be read from the
ecpDFifo as long as it is not empty.
ECP transfers may also be accomplished (albeit slowly) by handshaking individual bytes under program
control in mode = 001, or 000.
Termination from ECP Mode
Termination from ECP Mode is similar to the termination from Nibble/Byte Modes. The host is permitted to
terminate from ECP Mode only in specific well-defined states. The termination can only be executed while
the bus is in the forward direction. To terminate while the channel is in the reverse direction, it must first
be transitioned into the forward direction.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 96
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Command/Data
ECP Mode supports two advanced features to improve the effectiveness of the protocol for some
applications. The features are implemented by allowing the transfer of normal 8 bit data or 8 bit
commands.
When in the forward direction, normal data is transferred when HostAck is high and an 8 bit command is
transferred when HostAck is low.
The most significant bit of the command indicates whether it is a run-length count (for compression) or a
channel address.
When in the reverse direction, normal data is transferred when PeriphAck is high and an 8 bit command is
transferred when PeriphAck is low. The most significant bit of the command is always zero. Reverse
channel addresses are seldom used and may not be supported in hardware.
Table 12.7 - Forward Channel Commands (HostAck Low)
Reverse Channel Commands (PeripAck Low)
D7
0
1
D[6:0]
Run-Length Count (0-127) (mode 0011 0X00 only)
Channel Address (0-127)
12.4.2 Data Compression
The ECP port supports run length encoded (RLE) decompression in hardware and can transfer
compressed data to a peripheral. Run length encoded (RLE) compression in hardware is not supported.
To transfer compressed data in ECP mode, the compression count is written to the ecpAFifo and the data
byte is written to the ecpDFifo.
Compression is accomplished by counting identical bytes and transmitting an RLE byte that indicates how
many times the next byte is to be repeated. Decompression simply intercepts the RLE byte and repeats
the following byte the specified number of times. When a run-length count is received from a peripheral,
the subsequent data byte is replicated the specified number of times. A run-length count of zero specifies
that only one byte of data is represented by the next data byte, whereas a run-length count of 127
indicates that the next byte should be expanded to 128 bytes. To prevent data expansion, however,
run-length counts of zero should be avoided.
12.4.3 Pin Definition
The drivers for nStrobe, nAutoFd, nInit and nSelectIn are open-collector in mode 000 and are push-pull in
all other modes.
12.4.4 ISA Connections
The interface can never stall causing the host to hang. The width of data transfers is strictly controlled on
an I/O address basis per this specification. All FIFO-DMA transfers are byte wide, byte aligned and end on
a byte boundary. (The PWord value can be obtained by reading Configuration Register A, cnfgA,
described in the next section.) Single byte wide transfers are always possible with standard or PS/2 mode
using program control of the control signals.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 97
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
12.4.5 Interrupts
The interrupts are enabled by serviceIntr in the ecr register.
serviceIntr = 1
Disables the DMA and all of the service interrupts.
serviceIntr = 0
Enables the selected interrupt condition. If the interrupting condition is valid, then the
interrupt is generated immediately when this bit is changed from a 1 to a 0. This can
occur during Programmed I/O if the number of bytes removed or added from/to the FIFO
does not cross the threshold.
The interrupt generated is ISA friendly in that it must pulse the interrupt line low, allowing for interrupt
sharing. After a brief pulse low following the interrupt event, the interrupt line is tri-stated so that other
interrupts may assert.
An interrupt is generated when:
1.
2.
3.
4.
For DMA transfers: When serviceIntr is 0, dmaEn is 1 and the DMA TC is received.
For Programmed I/O:
a. When serviceIntr is 0, dmaEn is 0, direction is 0 and there are writeIntrThreshold or more free
bytes in the FIFO. Also, an interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is cleared to 0 whenever there
are writeIntrThreshold or more free bytes in the FIFO.
b. When serviceIntr is 0, dmaEn is 0, direction is 1 and there are readIntrThreshold or more bytes in
the FIFO. Also, an interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is cleared to 0 whenever there are
readIntrThreshold or more bytes in the FIFO.
When nErrIntrEn is 0 and nFault transitions from high to low or when nErrIntrEn is set from 1 to 0 and
nFault is asserted.
When ackIntEn is 1 and the nAck signal transitions from a low to a high.
12.4.6 FIFO Operation
The FIFO threshold is set in the chip configuration registers. All data transfers to or from the parallel port
can proceed in DMA or Programmed I/O (non-DMA) mode as indicated by the selected mode. The FIFO
is used by selecting the Parallel Port FIFO mode or ECP Parallel Port Mode. (FIFO test mode will be
addressed separately.) After a reset, the FIFO is disabled. Each data byte is transferred by a
Programmed I/O cycle or PDRQ depending on the selection of DMA or Programmed I/O mode.
The following paragraphs detail the operation of the FIFO flow control. In these descriptions, <threshold>
ranges from 1 to 16. The parameter FIFOTHR, which the user programs, is one less and ranges from 0 to
15.
A low threshold value (i.e. 2) results in longer periods of time between service requests, but requires faster
servicing of the request for both read and write cases. The host must be very responsive to the service
request. This is the desired case for use with a "fast" system. A high value of threshold (i.e. 12) is used
with a "sluggish" system by affording a long latency period after a service request, but results in more
frequent service requests.
12.5
DMA Transfers
DMA transfers are always to or from the ecpDFifo, tFifo or CFifo. DMA utilizes the standard PC DMA
services. To use the DMA transfers, the host first sets up the direction and state as in the programmed I/O
case. Then it programs the DMA controller in the host with the desired count and memory address. Lastly
it sets dmaEn to 1 and serviceIntr to 0. The ECP requests DMA transfers from the host by activating the
PDRQ pin. The DMA will empty or fill the FIFO using the appropriate direction and mode. When the
terminal count in the DMA controller is reached, an interrupt is generated and serviceIntr is asserted,
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 98
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
disabling DMA. In order to prevent possible blocking of refresh requests dReq shall not be asserted for
more than 32 DMA cycles in a row. The FIFO is enabled directly by asserting nPDACK and addresses
need not be valid. PINTR is generated when a TC is received. PDRQ must not be asserted for more than
32 DMA cycles in a row. After the 32nd cycle, PDRQ must be kept unasserted until nPDACK is
deasserted for a minimum of 350nsec. (Note: The only way to properly terminate DMA transfers is with a
TC.)
DMA may be disabled in the middle of a transfer by first disabling the host DMA controller. Then setting
serviceIntr to 1, followed by setting dmaEn to 0, and waiting for the FIFO to become empty or full.
Restarting the DMA is accomplished by enabling DMA in the host, setting dmaEn to 1, followed by setting
serviceIntr to 0.
DMA Mode - Transfers from the FIFO to the Host
(Note: In the reverse mode, the peripheral may not continue to fill the FIFO if it runs out of data to transfer,
even if the chip continues to request more data from the peripheral.)
The ECP activates the PDRQ pin whenever there is data in the FIFO. The DMA controller must respond
to the request by reading data from the FIFO. The ECP will deactivate the PDRQ pin when the FIFO
becomes empty or when the TC becomes true (qualified by nPDACK), indicating that no more data is
required. PDRQ goes inactive after nPDACK goes active for the last byte of a data transfer (or on the
active edge of nIOR, on the last byte, if no edge is present on nPDACK). If PDRQ goes inactive due to the
FIFO going empty, then PDRQ is active again as soon as there is one byte in the FIFO. If PDRQ goes
inactive due to the TC, then PDRQ is active again when there is one byte in the FIFO, and serviceIntr has
been re-enabled. (Note: A data underrun may occur if PDRQ is not removed in time to prevent an
unwanted cycle.)
12.5.1 Programmed I/O Mode or Non-DMA Mode
The ECP or parallel port FIFOs may also be operated using interrupt driven programmed I/O. Software
can determine the writeIntrThreshold, readIntrThreshold, and FIFO depth by accessing the FIFO in Test
Mode.
Programmed I/O transfers are to the ecpDFifo at 400H and ecpAFifo at 000H or from the ecpDFifo located
at 400H, or to/from the tFifo at 400H. To use the programmed I/O transfers, the host first sets up the
direction and state, sets dmaEn to 0 and serviceIntr to 0.
The ECP requests programmed I/O transfers from the host by activating the PINTR pin. The programmed
I/O will empty or fill the FIFO using the appropriate direction and mode.
Note:
A threshold of 16 is equivalent to a threshold of 15. These two cases are treated the same.
12.5.2 Programmed I/O - Transfers from the FIFO to the Host
In the reverse direction an interrupt occurs when serviceIntr is 0 and readIntrThreshold bytes are available
in the FIFO. If at this time the FIFO is full it can be emptied completely in a single burst, otherwise
readIntrThreshold bytes may be read from the FIFO in a single burst.
readIntrThreshold = (16-<threshold>) data bytes in FIFO
An interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is 0 and the number of bytes in the FIFO is greater than or
equal to (16-<threshold>). (If the threshold = 12, then the interrupt is set whenever there are 4-16 bytes in
the FIFO.) The PINT pin can be used for interrupt-driven systems. The host must respond to the request
by reading data from the FIFO. This process is repeated until the last byte is transferred out of the FIFO.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 99
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
If at this time the FIFO is full, it can be completely emptied in a single burst, otherwise a minimum of (16<threshold>) bytes may be read from the FIFO in a single burst.
12.5.3 Programmed I/O - Transfers from the Host to the FIFO
In the forward direction an interrupt occurs when serviceIntr is 0 and there are writeIntrThreshold or more
bytes free in the FIFO. At this time if the FIFO is empty it can be filled with a single burst before the empty
bit needs to be re-read. Otherwise it may be filled with writeIntrThreshold bytes.
writeIntrThreshold = (16-<threshold>) free bytes in FIFO
An interrupt is generated when serviceIntr is 0 and the number of bytes in the FIFO is less than or equal to
<threshold>. (If the threshold = 12, then the interrupt is set whenever there are 12 or less bytes of data in
the FIFO.) The PINT pin can be used for interrupt-driven systems. The host must respond to the request
by writing data to the FIFO. If at this time the FIFO is empty, it can be completely filled in a single burst,
otherwise a minimum of (16-<threshold>) bytes may be written to the FIFO in a single burst. This process
is repeated until the last byte is transferred into the FIFO.
12.6
Parallel Port Floppy Disk Controller
In this mode, the Floppy Disk Control signals are available on the parallel port pins. When this mode is
selected, the parallel port is not available. There are two modes of operation, PPFD1 and PPFD2. These
modes can be selected in the Parallel Port Mode Register, as defined in the Parallel Port Mode Register,
Logical Device 3, at 0xF1. PPFD1 has only drive 1 on the parallel port pins; PPFD2 has drive 0 and 1 on
the parallel port pins.
When the PPFDC is selected the following pins are set as follows:
1.
2.
3.
Note:
nPDACK: high-Z
PDRQ: not ECP = high-Z, ECP & dmaEn = 0, ECP & not dmaEn = high-Z
PINTR: not active, this is hi-Z or Low depending on settings.
nPDACK, PDRQ and PINTR refer to the nDACK, DRQ and IRQ chosen for the parallel port.
The following parallel port pins are read as follows by a read of the parallel port register:
1.
2.
3.
Data Register (read) = last Data Register (write)
Control Register read as "cable not connected" STROBE, AUTOFD and SLC = 0 and nINIT =1
Status Register reads: nBUSY = 0, PE = 0, SLCT = 0, nACK = 1, nERR = 1.
The following FDC pins are all in the high impedance state when the PPFDC is actually selected by the
drive select register:
1.
2.
nWDATA, DENSEL, nHDSEL, nWGATE, nDIR, nSTEP, nDS1, nDS0, nMTR0, nMTR1.
If PPFDx is selected, then the parallel port can not be used as a parallel port until "Normal" mode is
selected.
The FDC signals are muxed onto the Parallel Port pins as shown in Table 12.8.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 100
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 12.8 - FDC Parallel Port Pins
CONNECTOR
PIN #
1
CHIP PIN #
SPP MODE
PIN DIRECTION
FDC MODE
PIN DIRECTION
83
nSTROBE
I/O
(nDS0)
I/(O) Note 12.10
2
68
PD0
I/O
nINDEX
I
3
69
PD1
I/O
nTRK0
I
4
70
PD2
I/O
nWP
I
5
71
PD3
I/O
nRDATA
I
6
72
PD4
I/O
nDSKCHG
I
7
73
PD5
I/O
nMEDIA_ID0
I
8
74
PD6
I/O
(nMTR0)
I/(O) Note 12.10
9
75
PD7
I/O
MEDIA_ID1
I
10
80
nACK
I
nDS1
O
11
79
BUSY
I
nMTR1
O
12
78
PE
I
nWDATA
O
13
77
SLCT
I
nWGATE
O
14
82
nALF
I/O
DRVDEN0
O
15
81
nERROR
I
nHDSEL
O
16
66
nINIT
I/O
nDIR
O
17
67
nSLCTIN
I/O
nSTEP
O
Note 12.10 These pins are outputs in mode PPFD2, inputs in mode PPFD1.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 101
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 13 Auto Power Management
Power management capabilities are provided for the following logical devices: floppy disk, UART 1, UART
2 and the parallel port. For each logical device, two types of power management are provided; direct
powerdown and auto powerdown.
FDC Power Management
Direct power management is controlled by CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-B0. When set, this bit allows FDC to enter powerdown
when all of the following conditions have been met:
1.
2.
3.
4.
The motor enable pins of register 3F2H are inactive (zero).
The part must be idle; MSR=80H and INT = 0 (INT may be high even if MSR = 80H due to polling
interrupts).
The head unload timer must have expired.
The Auto powerdown timer (10msec) must have timed out.
An internal timer is initiated as soon as the auto powerdown command is enabled. The part is then
powered down when all the conditions are met.
Disabling the auto powerdown mode cancels the timer and holds the FDC block out of auto powerdown.
DSR From Powerdown
If DSR powerdown is used when the part is in auto powerdown, the DSR powerdown will override the auto
powerdown. However, when the part is awakened from DSR powerdown, the auto powerdown will once
again become effective.
Wake Up From Auto Powerdown
If the part enters the powerdown state through the auto powerdown mode, then the part can be awakened
by reset or by appropriate access to certain registers.
If a hardware or software reset is used then the part will go through the normal reset sequence. If the
access is through the selected registers, then the FDC resumes operation as though it was never in
powerdown. Besides activating the RESET pin or one of the software reset bits in the DOR or DSR, the
following register accesses will wake up the part:
1.
2.
3.
Enabling any one of the motor enable bits in the DOR register (reading the DOR does not awaken the
part).
A read from the MSR register.
A read or write to the Data register.
Once awake, the FDC will reinitiate the auto powerdown timer for 10 ms. The part will powerdown again
when all the powerdown conditions are satisfied.
Register Behavior
Table 13.1 reiterates the AT and PS/2 (including Model 30) configuration registers available. It also shows
the type of access permitted. In order to maintain software transparency, access to all the registers must
be maintained. As Table 13.1 shows, two sets of registers are distinguished based on whether their
access results in the part remaining in powerdown state or exiting it.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 102
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Access to all other registers is possible without awakening the part. These registers can be accessed
during powerdown without changing the status of the part. A read from these registers will reflect the true
status as shown in the register description in the FDC description. A write to the part will result in the part
retaining the data and subsequently reflecting it when the part awakens. Accessing the part during
powerdown may cause an increase in the power consumption by the part. The part will revert back to its
low power mode when the access has been completed.
Pin Behavior
The FDC37C672 is specifically designed for portable PC systems in which power conservation is a
primary concern. This makes the behavior of the pins during powerdown very important.
The pins of the FDC37C672 can be divided into two major categories: system interface and floppy disk
drive interface. The floppy disk drive pins are disabled so that no power will be drawn through the part as
a result of any voltage applied to the pin within the part's power supply range. Most of the system
interface pins are left active to monitor system accesses that may wake up the part.
System Interface Pins
Table 12.8 gives the state of the system interface pins in the powerdown state. Pins unaffected by the
powerdown are labeled "Unchanged". Input pins are "Disabled" to prevent them from causing currents
internal to the FDC37C672 when they have indeterminate input values.
Table 13.1 - PC/AT and PS/2 Available Registers
BASE + ADDRESS
00H
01H
02H
03H
04H
06H
07H
07H
04H
05H
AVAILABLE REGISTERS
ACCESS PERMITTED
PC-AT
PS/2 (MODEL 30)
Access to these registers DOES NOT wake up the part
---SRA
R
---SRB
R
DOR (Note 13.1) DOR (Note 13.1)
R/W
------DSR (Note 13.1) DSR (Note 13.1)
W
------DIR
DIR
R
CCR
CCR
W
Access to these registers wakes up the part
MSR
MSR
R
Data
Data
R/W
Note 13.1 Writing to the DOR or DSR does not wake up the part, however, writing any of the motor enable bits or
doing a software reset (via DOR or DSR reset bits) will wake up the part
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 103
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 13.2 - State of System Pins in Auto Powerdown
SYSTEM PINS STATE IN AUTO POWERDOWN
INPUT PINS
nIOR
Unchanged
nIOW
Unchanged
SA[0:9]
Unchanged
SD[0:7]
Unchanged
RESET_DRV
Unchanged
DACKx
Unchanged
TC
Unchanged
Output Pins
IRQx
Unchanged (low)
SD[0:7]
Unchanged
DRQx
Unchanged (low)
FDD Interface Pins
All pins in the FDD interface which can be connected directly to the floppy disk drive itself are either
DISABLED or TRISTATED.
Pins used for local logic control or part programming are unaffected. Table 13.3 depicts the state of the
floppy disk drive interface pins in the powerdown state.
Table 13.3 - State of Floppy Disk Drive Interface Pins in Powerdown
FDD Pins
State in Auto Powerdown
Input Pins
nRDATA
Input
nWPROT
Input
nTR0
Input
nINDEX
Input
nDSKCHG
Input
Output Pins
nMTR[0:1]
Tristated
nDS[0:1]
Tristated
nDIR
Active
nSTEP
Active
nWDATA
Tristated
nWGATE
Tristated
nHDSEL
Active
DRVDEN[0:1]
Active
UART Power Management
Direct power management is controlled by CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-B4 and B5. When set, these bits allow the following auto
power management operations:
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 104
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
1.
2.
Note:
The transmitter enters auto powerdown when the transmit buffer and shift register are empty.
The receiver enters powerdown when the following conditions are all met:
a. Receive FIFO is empty
b. The receiver is waiting for a start bit.
While in powerdown the Ring Indicator interrupt is still valid and transitions when the RI input changes.
Exit Auto Powerdown
The transmitter exits powerdown on a write to the XMIT buffer. The receiver exits auto powerdown when
RXDx changes state.
Parallel Port
Direct power management is controlled by CR22. Refer to CR22 for more information.
Auto Power Management is enabled by CR23-B3. When set, this bit allows the ECP or EPP logical
parallel port blocks to be placed into powerdown when not being used.
The EPP logic is in powerdown under any of the following conditions:
1.
2.
EPP is not enabled in the configuration registers.
EPP is not selected through ecr while in ECP mode.
The ECP logic is in powerdown under any of the following conditions:
1.
2.
ECP is not enabled in the configuration registers.
SPP, PS/2 Parallel port or EPP mode is selected through ecr while in ECP mode.
Exit Auto Powerdown
The parallel port logic can change powerdown modes when the ECP mode is changed through the ecr
register or when the parallel port mode is changed through the configuration registers.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 105
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 14 Serial IRQ
The SMI is enabled onto the SMI frame of the Serial IRQ via bit 6 of SMI Enable Register 2 and onto the
SMI pin via bit 7 of the SMI Enable Register 2.
14.1
Serial Interrupts
The FDC37C672 will support the serial interrupt to transmit interrupt information to the host system. The
serial interrupt scheme adheres to the Serial IRQ Specification for PCI Systems, Version 6.0.
14.1.1 Timing Diagrams For IRQSER Cycle
PCICLK = 33Mhz_IN pin
IRQSER = SIRQ pin
A.
Start Frame timing with source sampled a low pulse on IRQ1
SL
or
H
START FRAME
H
R
IRQ0 FRAME IRQ1 FRAME IRQ2 FRAME
T
S
R
T
S
R
T
S
R
T
PCICLK
START1
IRQSER
Drive Source
IRQ1
H=Host Control
SL=Slave Control
S=Sample
Note1:
None
Host Controller
IRQ1
None
R=Recovery
T=Turn-around
Start Frame pulse can be 4-8 clocks wide.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 106
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
B.
Stop Frame Timing with Host using 17 IRQSER sampling period
IRQ14
FRAME
S R T
IRQ15
FRAME
S R T
IOCHCK#
FRAME
S R T
STOP FRAME
I
2
H
R
NEXT CYCLE
T
PCICLK
STOP1
IRQSER
Driver
None
IRQ15
None
START3
Host Controller
H=Host Control
T=Turn-around
R=Recovery
S=Sample
I= Idle.
Note 1
Stop pulse is 2 clocks wide for Quiet mode, 3 clocks wide for Continuous mode.
Note 2
There may be none, one or more Idle states during the Stop Frame.
Note 3
The next IRQSER cycle’s Start Frame pulse may or may not start immediately after the turn-around clock
of the Stop Frame.
14.1.2 IRQSER Cycle Control
There are two modes of operation for the IRQSER Start Frame.
1.
Quiet (Active) Mode: Any device may initiate a Start Frame by driving the IRQSER low for one clock,
while the IRQSER is Idle. After driving low for one clock the IRQSER must immediately be tri-stated
without at any time driving high. A Start Frame may not be initiated while the IRQSER is Active. The
IRQSER is Idle between Stop and Start Frames. The IRQSER is Active between Start and Stop
Frames. This mode of operation allows the IRQSER to be Idle when there are no IRQ/Data transitions
which should be most of the time.
Once a Start Frame has been initiated the Host Controller will take over driving the IRQSER low in the
next clock and will continue driving the IRQSER low for a programmable period of three to seven
clocks. This makes a total low pulse width of four to eight clocks. Finally, the Host Controller will
drive the IRQSER back high for one clock, then tri-state.
Any IRQSER Device (i.e., The FDC37C672) which detects any transition on an IRQ/Data line for
which it is responsible must initiate a Start Frame in order to update the Host Controller unless the
IRQSER is already in an IRQSER Cycle and the IRQ/Data transition can be delivered in that IRQSER
Cycle.
2.
Continuous (Idle) Mode: Only the Host controller can initiate a Start Frame to update IRQ/Data line
information. All other IRQSER agents become passive and may not initiate a Start Frame. IRQSER
will be driven low for four to eight clocks by Host Controller. This mode has two functions. It can be
used to stop or idle the IRQSER or the Host Controller can operate IRQSER in a continuous mode by
initiating a Start Frame at the end of every Stop Frame.
An IRQSER mode transition can only occur during the Stop Frame. Upon reset, IRQSER bus is
defaulted to Continuous mode, therefore only the Host controller can initiate the first Start Frame.
Slaves must continuously sample the Stop Frames pulse width to determine the next IRQSER Cycle’s
mode.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 107
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
14.1.3 IRQSER Data Frame
Once a Start Frame has been initiated, the FDC37C672 will watch for the rising edge of the Start Pulse
and start counting IRQ/Data Frames from there. Each IRQ/Data Frame is three clocks: Sample phase,
Recovery phase, and Turn-around phase. During the Sample phase the FDC37C672 must drive the
IRQSER (SIRQ pin) low, if and only if, its last detected IRQ/Data value was low. If its detected IRQ/Data
value is high, IRQSER must be left tri-stated. During the Recovery phase the FDC37C672 must drive the
SERIRQ high, if and only if, it had driven the IRQSER low during the previous Sample Phase. During the
Turn-around Phase the FDC37C672 must tri-state the SERIRQ. The FDC37C672 will drive the IRQSER
line low at the appropriate sample point if its associated IRQ/Data line is low, regardless of which device
initiated the Start Frame.
The Sample Phase for each IRQ/Data follows the low to high transition of the Start Frame pulse by a
number of clocks equal to the IRQ/Data Frame times three, minus one. (e.g.: The IRQ5 Sample clock is
the sixth IRQ/Data Frame, (6 x 3) - 1 = 17th clock after the rising edge of the Start Pulse.)
Table 14.1 - IRQSER Sampling Periods
IRQSER PERIOD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
SIGNAL SAMPLED
Not Used
IRQ1
nSMI/IRQ2
IRQ3
IRQ4
IRQ5
IRQ6
IRQ7
IRQ8
IRQ9
IRQ10
IRQ11
IRQ12
IRQ13
IRQ14
IRQ15
# OF CLOCKS PAST START
2
5
8
11
14
17
20
23
26
29
32
35
38
41
44
47
The SIRQ data frame will now support IRQ2 from a logical device, previously IRQSER Period 3 was
reserved for use by the System Management Interrupt (nSMI). When using Period 3 for IRQ2 the user
should mask off the SMI via the SMI Enable Register. Likewise, when using Period 3 for nSMI the user
should not configure any logical devices as using IRQ2.
IRQSER Period 14 is used to transfer IRQ13. Logical devices 0 (FDC), 3 (Par Port), 4 (Ser Port 1), 5 (Ser
Port 2), 6 (RTC), and 7 (KBD) shall have IRQ13 as a choice for their primary interrupt.
14.1.4 Stop Cycle Control
Once all IRQ/Data Frames have completed the Host Controller will terminate IRQSER activity by initiating
a Stop Frame. Only the Host Controller can initiate the Stop Frame. A Stop Frame is indicated when the
IRQSER is low for two or three clocks. If the Stop Frame’s low time is two clocks then the next IRQSER
Cycle’s sampled mode is the Quiet mode; and any IRQSER device may initiate a Start Frame in the
second clock or more after the rising edge of the Stop Frame’s pulse. If the Stop Frame’s low time is three
clocks then the next IRQSER Cycle’s sampled mode is the Continuous mode; and only the Host Controller
may initiate a Start Frame in the second clock or more after the rising edge of the Stop Frame’s pulse.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 108
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
14.1.5 Latency
Latency for IRQ/Data updates over the IRQSER bus in bridge-less systems with the minimum IRQ/Data
Frames of seventeen, will range up to 96 clocks (3.84µS with a 25MHz PCI Bus or 2.88uS with a 33MHz
PCI Bus). If one or more PCI to PCI Bridge is added to a system, the latency for IRQ/Data updates from
the secondary or tertiary buses will be a few clocks longer for synchronous buses, and approximately
double for asynchronous buses.
14.1.6 EOI/ISR Read Latency
Any serialized IRQ scheme has a potential implementation issue related to IRQ latency. IRQ latency could
cause an EOI or ISR Read to precede an IRQ transition that it should have followed. This could cause a
system fault. The host interrupt controller is responsible for ensuring that these latency issues are
mitigated. The recommended solution is to delay EOIs and ISR Reads to the interrupt controller by the
same amount as the IRQSER Cycle latency in order to ensure that these events do not occur out of order.
14.1.7 AC/DC Specification Issue
All IRQSER agents must drive / sample IRQSER synchronously related to the rising edge of PCI bus
clock. IRQSER (SIRQ) pin uses the electrical specification of PCI bus. Electrical parameters will follow
PCI spec. section 4, sustained tri-state.
14.1.8 Reset and Initialization
The IRQSER bus uses RESET_DRV as its reset signal. The IRQSER pin is tri-stated by all agents while
RESET_DRV is active. With reset, IRQSER Slaves are put into the (continuous) IDLE mode. The Host
Controller is responsible for starting the initial IRQSER Cycle to collect system’s IRQ/Data default values.
The system then follows with the Continuous/Quiet mode protocol (Stop Frame pulse width) for
subsequent IRQSER Cycles. It is Host Controller’s responsibility to provide the default values to 8259’s
and other system logic before the first IRQSER Cycle is performed. For IRQSER system suspend,
insertion, or removal application, the Host controller should be programmed into Continuous (IDLE) mode
first. This is to guarantee IRQSER bus is in IDLE state before the system configuration changes.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 109
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 15 GP Index Registers
The Watchdog Timer Control, SMI Enable and SMI Status Registers can be accessed by the host when
the chip is in the normal run mode if CR03 Bit[7]=1. The host uses GP Index and Data register to access
these registers. The Power on default GP Index and Data registers are 0xEA and 0xEB respectively. In
configuration mode the GP Index address may be programmed to reside on addresses 0xE0, 0xE2, 0xE4
or 0xEA. The GP Data address is automatically set to the Index address + 1. Upon exiting the
configuration mode the new GP Index and Data registers are used to access registers WDT_CTRL, SMI
Enable and SMI Status Registers.
To access these registers when in normal (run) mode, the host should perform an IOW of the Register
Index to the GP Index register (at 0xEX) to select the Register and then read or write the Data register (at
Index+1) to access the register.
The WDT_CTRL, SMI Enable and SMI Status registers can also be accessed by the host when in the
configuration state through Logical Device 8.
Table 15.1 - GP Index and Data Register
REGISTER
GP Index
GP Data
ADDRESS (R/W)
0xE0, E2, E4, EA
Index address + 1
NORMAL (RUN) MODE
0x01-0x0F
Access to Watchdog Timer Control,
SMI Enable and SMI Status
Registers (see Table 15.2)
Table 15.2- Index and Data Register Normal (Run) Mode
INDEX
0x01
0x02
0x03
0x04
0x05
0x06
0x07
0x08
0x09
0x0A
0x0B
0x0C
0x0D
0x0E
0x0F
Note:
NORMAL (RUN) MODE
Reserved
Reserved
Access to Watchdog Timer Control (L8 - CRF4)
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Access to SMI Enable Register 1 (L8-CRB4)
Access to SMI Enable Register 2 (L8-CRB5)
Access to SMI Status Register 1 (L8-CRB6)
Access to SMI Status Register 2 (L8-CRB7)
These registers can also be accessed through the configuration registers at L8 - CRxx shown in the table
above.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 110
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 16 Watch Dog Timer
The FDC37C672 contains a Watch Dog Timer (WDT). The Watch Dog Time-out status bit may be mapped
to an interrupt through the WDT_CFG Configuration Register.
The FDC37C672's WDT has a programmable time-out ranging from 1 to 255 minutes with one minute
resolution, or 1 to 255 seconds with 1 second resolution. The units of the WDT timeout value are selected
via bit[7] of the WDT_TIMEOUT register (LD8:CRF1.7). The WDT time-out value is set through the
WDT_VAL Configuration register. Setting the WDT_VAL register to 0x00 disables the WDT function (this
is its power on default). Setting the WDT_VAL to any other non-zero value will cause the WDT to reload
and begin counting down from the value loaded. When the WDT count value reaches zero the counter
stops and sets the Watchdog time-out status bit in the WDT_CTRL Configuration Register.
Note:
Regardless of the current state of the WDT, the WDT time-out status bit can be directly set or cleared by
the Host CPU.
There are three system events which can reset the WDT, these are a Keyboard Interrupt, a Mouse
Interrupt, or I/O reads/writes to address 0x201 (the internal or an external Joystick Port). The effect on the
WDT for each of these system events may be individually enabled or disabled through bits in the
WDT_CFG configuration register. When a system event is enabled through the WDT_CFG register, the
occurrence of that event will cause the WDT to reload the value stored in WDT_VAL and reset the WDT
time-out status bit if set. If all three system events are disabled the WDT will inevitably time out.
The Watch Dog Timer may be configured to generate an interrupt on the rising edge of the Time-out status
bit. The WDT interrupt is mapped to an interrupt channel through the WDT_CFG Configuration Register.
When mapped to an interrupt the interrupt request pin reflects the value of the WDT time-out status bit.
The host may force a Watch Dog time-out to occur by writing a "1" to bit 2 of the WDT_CTRL (Force WD
Time-out) Configuration Register. Writing a "1" to this bit forces the WDT count value to zero and sets bit 0 of
the WDT_CTRL (Watch Dog Status). Bit 2 of the WDT_CTRL is self-clearing.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 111
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 17 8042 Keyboard Controller Description
The FDC37C672 is a Super I/O and Universal Keyboard Controller that is designed for intelligent keyboard
management in desktop computer applications. The Super I/O supports a Floppy Disk Controller, two
16550 type serial ports one ECP/EPP Parallel Port.
The Universal Keyboard Controller uses an 8042 microcontroller CPU core. This section concentrates on
the FDC37C672 enhancements to the 8042. For general information about the 8042, refer to the "Hardware Description of the 8042" in the 8-Bit Embedded Controller Handbook.
8042A
LS05
P27
P10
KDAT
P26
TST0
KCLK
P23
TST1
MCLK
P22
P11
MDAT
Figure 17.1 - Keyboard and Mouse Interface
Notes:
KIRQ is the Keyboard IRQ
MIRQ is the Mouse IRQ
Port 21 is used to create a GATEA20 signal from the FDC37C672.
17.1
Keyboard ISA Interface
The FDC37C672 ISA interface is functionally compatible with the 8042 style host interface. It consists of
the D0-7 data bus; the nIOR, nIOW and the Status register, Input Data register, and Output Data register.
Table 17.1 shows how the interface decodes the control signals. In addition to the above signals, the host
interface includes keyboard and mouse IRQs.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 112
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 17.1 - ISA I/O Address Map
ISA ADDRESS
0x60
0x64
NIOW
0
1
0
1
NIOR
1
0
1
0
BLOCK
KDATA
KDATA
KDCTL
KDCTL
FUNCTION (Note 17.1)
Keyboard Data Write (C/D=0)
Keyboard Data Read
Keyboard Command Write (C/D=1)
Keyboard Status Read
Note 17.1 These registers consist of three separate 8 bit registers. Status, Data/Command Write and Data Read.
17.1.1 Keyboard Data Write
This is an 8 bit write only register. When written, the C/D status bit of the status register is cleared to zero
and the IBF bit is set.
17.1.2 Keyboard Data Read
This is an 8 bit read only register. If enabled by "ENABLE FLAGS", when read, the KIRQ output is cleared
and the OBF flag in the status register is cleared. If not enabled, the KIRQ and/or AUXOBF1 must be
cleared in software.
17.1.3 Keyboard Command Write
This is an 8 bit write only register. When written, the C/D status bit of the status register is set to one and
the IBF bit is set.
17.1.4 Keyboard Status Read
This is an 8 bit read only register. Refer to the description of the Status Register for more information.
17.1.5 CPU-to-Host Communication
The FDC37C672 CPU can write to the Output Data register via register DBB. A write to this register automatically sets Bit 0 (OBF) in the Status register. See Table 17.2.
Table 17.2 - Host Interface Flags
8042 INSTRUCTION
OUT DBB
FLAG
Set OBF, and, if enabled, the KIRQ output signal goes high
17.1.6 Host-to-CPU Communication
The host system can send both commands and data to the Input Data register. The CPU differentiates
between commands and data by reading the value of Bit 3 of the Status register. When bit 3 is "1", the
CPU interprets the register contents as a command. When bit 3 is "0", the CPU interprets the register
contents as data. During a host write operation, bit 3 is set to "1" if SA2 = 1 or reset to "0" if SA2 = 0.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 113
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
17.1.7 KIRQ
If "EN FLAGS" has been executed and P24 is set to a one: the OBF flag is gated onto KIRQ. The KIRQ
signal can be connected to system interrupt to signify that the FDC37C672 CPU has written to the output
data register via "OUT DBB,A". If P24 is set to a zero, KIRQ is forced low. On power-up, after a valid RST
pulse has been delivered to the device, KIRQ is reset to 0. KIRQ will normally reflects the status of writes
"DBB". (KIRQ is normally selected as IRQ1 for keyboard support.)
If "EN FLAGS” has not been executed: KIRQ can be controlled by writing to P24. Writing a zero to P24
forces KIRQ low; a high forces KIRQ high.
17.1.8 MIRQ
If "EN FLAGS" has been executed and P25 is set to a one:; IBF is inverted and gated onto MIRQ. The
MIRQ signal can be connected to system interrupt to signify that the FDC37C672 CPU has read the DBB
register.
If "EN FLAGS” has not been executed, MIRQ is controlled by P25. Writing a zero to P25 forces MIRQ low,
a high forces MIRQ high. (MIRQ is normally selected as IRQ12 for mouse support.)
17.1.9 Gate A20
A general purpose P21 is used as a software controlled Gate A20 or user defined output.
17.2
External Keyboard and Mouse Interface
Industry-standard PC-AT-compatible keyboards employ a two-wire, bidirectional TTL interface for data
transmission. Several sources also supply PS/2 mouse products that employ the same type of interface.
To facilitate system expansion, the FDC37C672 provides four signal pins that may be used to implement
this interface directly for an external keyboard and mouse.
The FDC37C672 has four high-drive, open-drain output, bidirectional port pins that can be used for external
serial interfaces, such as ISA external keyboard and PS/2-type mouse interfaces. They are KCLK, KDAT,
MCLK, and MDAT. P26 is inverted and output as KCLK. The KCLK pin is connected to TEST0. P27 is inverted
and output as KDAT. The KDAT pin is connected to P10. P23 is inverted and output as MCLK. The MCLK pin is
connected to TEST1. P22 is inverted and output as MDAT. The MDAT pin is connected to P11.
Note:
External pull-ups may be required.
17.3
Keyboard Power Management
The keyboard provides support for two power-saving modes: soft powerdown mode and hard powerdown
mode. In soft powerdown mode, the clock to the ALU is stopped but the timer/counter and interrupts are
still active. In hard power down mode the clock to the 8042 is stopped.
17.3.1 Soft Power Down Mode
This mode is entered by executing a HALT instruction. The execution of program code is halted until
either RESET is driven active or a data byte is written to the DBBIN register by a master CPU. If this
mode is exited using the interrupt, and the IBF interrupt is enabled, then program execution resumes with
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 114
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
a CALL to the interrupt routine, otherwise the next instruction is executed. If it is exited using RESET then
a normal reset sequence is initiated and program execution starts from program memory location 0.
17.3.2 Hard Power Down Mode
This mode is entered by executing a STOP instruction. The oscillator is stopped by disabling the oscillator
driver cell. When either RESET is driven active or a data byte is written to the DBBIN register by a master
CPU, this mode will be exited (as above). However, as the oscillator cell will require an initialization time,
either RESET must be held active for sufficient time to allow the oscillator to stabilize. Program execution
will resume as above.
17.4
Interrupts
The FDC37C672 provides the two 8042 interrupts. IBF and the Timer/Counter Overflow.
17.5
Memory Configurations
The FDC37C672 provides 2K of on-chip ROM and 256 bytes of on-chip RAM.
17.5.1 Register Definitions
Host I/F Data Register
The Input Data register and Output Data register are each 8 bits wide. A write to this 8 bit register will load
the Keyboard Data Read Buffer, set the OBF flag and set the KIRQ output if enabled. A read of this
register will read the data from the Keyboard Data or Command Write Buffer and clear the IBF flag. Refer
to the KIRQ and Status register descriptions for more information.
Host I/F Status Register
The Status register is 8 bits wide. Table 17.3 shows the contents of the Status register.
Table 17.3 - Status Register
D7
UD
D6
UD
D5
UD
D4
UD
D3
C/D
D2
UD
D1
IBF
D0
OBF
17.5.2 Status Register
This register is cleared on a reset. This register is read-only for the Host and read/write by the FDC37C672
CPU.
UD
Writable by FDC37C672 CPU. These bits are user-definable.
C/D
(Command Data) -This bit specifies whether the input data register contains data or a command
(0 = data, 1 = command). During a host data/command write operation, this bit is set to "1" if SA2
= 1 or reset to "0" if SA2 = 0.
IBF
(Input Buffer Full) - This flag is set to 1 whenever the host system writes data into the input data
register. Setting this flag activates the FDC37C672 CPU's nIBF (MIRQ) interrupt if enabled.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 115
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
When the FDC37C672 CPU reads the input data register (DBB), this bit is automatically reset
and the interrupt is cleared. There is no output pin associated with this internal signal.
OBF
17.6
(Output Buffer Full) - This flag is set to whenever the FDC37C672 CPU write to the output data
register (DBB). When the host system reads the output data register, this bit is automatically
reset.
External Clock Signal
The FDC37C672 Keyboard Controller clock source is a 12 MHz clock generated from a 14.318 MHz clock.
The reset pulse must last for at least 24 16 Mhz clock periods. The pulse-width requirement applies to
both internally (Vcc POR) and externally generated reset signals. In powerdown mode, the external clock
signal is not loaded by the chip.
17.7
Default Reset Conditions
The FDC37C672 has one source of reset: an external reset via the RESET_DRV pin. Refer to Table 17.4
for the effect of each type of reset on the internal registers.
Table 17.4 - Resets
DESCRIPTION
KCLK
KDAT
MCLK
MDAT
Host I/F Data Reg
Host I/F Status Reg
HARDWARE RESET (RESET)
Weak High
Weak High
Weak High
Weak High
N/A
00H
Note:
N/A: Not Applicable
17.8
GATEA20 and Keyboard Reset
The FDC37C672 provides two options for GateA20 and Keyboard Reset: 8042 Software Generated
GateA20 and KRESET and Port 92 Fast GateA20 and KRESET.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 116
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
17.9
Port 92 Fast GATEA20 and Keyboard Reset
17.9.1 Port 92 Register
This port can only be read or written if Port 92 has been enabled via bit 2 of the KRST_GA20 Register
(Logical Device 7, 0xF0) set to 1.
This register is used to support the alternate reset (nALT_RST) and alternate A20 (ALT_A20) functions.
Name
Location
Default Value
Attribute
Size
Port 92
92h
24h
Read/Write
8 bits
PORT 92 REGISTER
BIT
7:6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FUNCTION
Reserved. Returns 00 when read.
Reserved. Returns a 1 when read.
Reserved. Returns a 0 when read.
Reserved. Returns a 0 when read.
Reserved. Returns a 1 when read.
ALT_A20 Signal control. Writing a 0 to this bit causes the ALT_A20 signal to
be driven low. Writing a 1 to this bit causes the ALT_A20 signal to be driven
high.
Alternate System Reset. This read/write bit provides an alternate system reset
function. This function provides an alternate means to reset the system CPU
to effect a mode switch from Protected Virtual Address Mode to the Real
Address Mode. This provides a faster means of reset than is provided by the
Keyboard controller. This bit is set to a 0 by a system reset. Writing a 1 to this
bit will cause the nALT_RST signal to pulse active (low) for a minimum of 1 µs
after a delay of 500 ns. Before another nALT_RST pulse can be generated,
this bit must be written back to a 0.
NGATEA20
8042
P21
0
0
1
1
ALT_A20
0
1
0
1
SYSTEM
NA20M
0
1
1
1
Bit 0 of Port 92, which generates the nALT_RST signal, is used to reset the CPU under program control.
This signal is AND’ed together externally with the reset signal (nKBDRST) from the keyboard controller to
provide a software means of resetting the CPU. This provides a faster means of reset than is provided by
the keyboard controller. Writing a 1 to bit 0 in the Port 92 Register causes this signal to pulse low for a
minimum of 6µs, after a delay of a minimum of 14µs. Before another nALT_RST pulse can be generated,
bit 0 must be set to 0 either by a system reset of a write to Port 92. Upon reset, this signal is driven
inactive high (bit 0 in the Port 92 Register is set to 0).
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 117
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
If Port 92 is enabled, i.e., bit 2 of KRST_GA20 is set to 1, then a pulse is generated by writing a 1 to bit 0
of the Port 92 Register and this pulse is AND’ed with the pulse generated from the 8042. This pulse is
output on pin KRESET and its polarity is controlled by the GPI/O polarity configuration.
14us
~
~
6us
8042
P20
KRST
KBDRST
KRST_GA20
Bit 2
P92
nALT_RST
Bit 0
Pulse
Gen
14us
~
~
Note: When Port 92 is disabled,
writes are ignored and reads
return undefined values.
6us
KRESET Generation
Bit 1 of Port 92, the ALT_A20 signal, is used to force nA20M to the CPU low for support of real mode
compatible software. This signal is externally OR’ed with the A20GATE signal from the keyboard
controller and CPURST to control the nA20M input of the CPU. Writing a 0 to bit 1 of the Port 92 Register
forces ALT_A20 low. ALT_A20 low drives nA20M to the CPU low, if A20GATE from the keyboard
controller is also low. Writing a 1 to bit 1 of the Port 92 Register forces ALT_A20 high. ALT_A20 high
drives nA20M to the CPU high, regardless of the state of A20GATE from the keyboard controller. Upon
reset, this signal is driven low.
17.9.2 8042 P12 and P16 Functions
8042 functions P12 and P16 are implemented as in a true 8042 part. Reference the 8042 spec for all
timing. A port signal of 0 drives the output to 0. A port signal of 1 causes the port enable signal to drive the
output to 1 within 20-30nsec. After several (# TBD) clocks, the port enable goes away and the internal
90µA pull-up maintains the output signal as 1.
In 8042 mode, the pins can be programmed as open drain. When programmed in open drain mode, the
port enables do not come into play. If the port signal is 0 the output will be 0. If the port signal is 1, the
output tristates: an external pull-up can pull the pin high, and the pin can be shared i.e., P12 and nSMI can
be externally tied together. In 8042 mode, the pins cannot be programmed as input nor inverted through
the GP configuration registers.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 118
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
0ns
250ns
500ns
CLK
AEN
nAEN
64=I/O Addr
n64
nIOW
nA
DD1
nDD1
nCNTL
nIOW'
nIOW+n64
AfterD1
nAfterD1
60=I/O Addr
n60
nIOW+n60=B
nAfterD1+B
D[1]
GA20
Figure 17.2 - Gate A20 Turn-On Sequence Timing
When writing to the command and data port with hardware speedup, the IOW timing shown in the figure
titled “IOW Timing for Port 92” in the Timing Diagrams Section is used. This setup time is only required to
be met when using hardware speedup; the data must be valid a minimum of 0 nsec from the leading edge
of the write and held throughout the entire write cycle.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 119
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 18 System Management Interrupt (SMI)
The FDC37C672 implements a group nSMI output pin. The System Management Interrupt is a nonmaskable interrupt with the highest priority level used for transparent power management. The nSMI
group interrupt output consists of the enabled interrupts from each of the functional blocks in the chip. The
interrupts are enabled onto the group nSMI output via the SMI Enable Registers 1 and 2. The nSMI output
is then enabled onto the group nSMI output pin via bit[7] in the SMI Enable Register 2.
The logic equation for the nSMI output is as follows:
nSMI = (EN_PINT and IRQ_PINT) or (EN_U2INT and IRQ_U2INT) or (EN_U1INT and IRQ_U1INT) or
(EN_FINT and IRQ_FINT) or (EN_WDT and IRQ_WDT) or (EN_MINT and IRQ_MINT) or
(EN_KINT and IRQ_KINT) or (EN_IRINT and IRQ_IRINT)
18.1
Registers
The following registers can be accessed when in configuration mode at Logical Device 8, Registers B4-B7
and when not in configuration they can be accessed through the Index and Data Register (refer to Table
15.2).
18.1.1 SMI Enable Registers
SMI Enable Register 1
(Configuration Register B4, Logical Device 8)
This register is used to enable the different interrupt sources onto the group nSMI output.
SMI Enable Register 2
(Configuration Register B5, Logical Device 8)
This register is used to enable additional interrupt sources onto the group nSMI output. This register is also
used to enable the group nSMI output onto the nSMI Serial/Parallel IRQ pin and the routing of 8042 P12
internally to nSMI.
18.1.2 SMI Status Registers
SMI Status Register 1
(Configuration Register B6, Logical Device 8)
This register is used to read the status of the SMI input events.
Note:
The status bit gets set whether or not the interrupt is enabled onto the group SMI output.
SMI Status Register 2
(Configuration Register B7, Logical Device 8)
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 120
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 19 Configuration
The Configuration of the FDC37C672 is very flexible and is based on the configuration architecture
implemented in typical Plug-and-Play components. The FDC37C672 is designed for motherboard
applications in which the resources required by their components are known. With its flexible resource
allocation architecture, the FDC37C672 allows the BIOS to assign resources at POST.
19.1
System Elements
19.1.1 Primary Configuration Address Decoder
After a hard reset (RESET_DRV pin asserted) or Vcc Power On Reset the FDC37C672 is in the Run
Mode with all logical devices disabled. The logical devices may be configured through two standard
Configuration I/O Ports (INDEX and DATA) by placing the FDC37C672 into Configuration Mode. The
BIOS uses these configuration ports to initialize the logical devices at POST. The INDEX and DATA ports
are only valid when the FDC37C672 is in Configuration Mode.
The SYSOPT pin is latched on the falling edge of the RESET_DRV or on Vcc Power On Reset to
determine the configuration register's base address. The SYSOPT pin is used to select the CONFIG
PORT's I/O address at power-up. Once powered up the configuration port base address can be changed
through configuration registers CR26 and CR27. The SYSOPT pin is a hardware configuration pin
which is shared with the nRTS1 signal on pin 87. During reset this pin is a weak active low signal which
sinks 30µA.
Note:
All I/O addresses are qualified with AEN.
The INDEX and DATA ports are effective only when the chip is in the Configuration State.
PORT NAME
CONFIG PORT (Note 19.2)
INDEX PORT (Note 19.2)
DATA PORT
SYSOPT= 0
(PULL-DOWN RESISTOR)
REFER TO Note 19.1
0x03F0
0x03F0
INDEX PORT + 1
SYSOPT= 1
(10K PULL-UP RESISTOR)
0x0370
0x0370
TYPE
Write
Read/Write
Read/Write
Note 19.1 If using TTL RS232 drivers use 1K pull-down. If using CMOS RS232 drivers use 10K pull-down.
Note 19.2 The configuration port base address can be relocated through CR26 and CR27.
19.1.2 Entering the Configuration State
The device enters the Configuration State when the following Config Key is successfully written to the
CONFIG PORT.
Config Key = < 0x55 >
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 121
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
19.1.3 Exiting the Configuration State
The device exits the Configuration State when the following Config Key is successfully written to the
CONFIG PORT.
Config Key = < 0xAA>
19.2
Configuration Sequence
To program the configuration registers, the following sequence must be followed:
1.
2.
3.
Enter Configuration Mode
Configure the Configuration Registers
Exit Configuration Mode.
19.2.1 Enter Configuration Mode
To place the chip into the Configuration State the Config Key is sent to the chip's CONFIG PORT. The
config key consists of 0x55 written to the CONFIG PORT. Once the configuration key is received correctly
the chip enters into the Configuration State. (The auto Config ports are enabled.)
19.2.2 Configuration Mode
The system sets the logical device information and activates desired logical devices through the INDEX
and DATA ports. In configuration mode, the INDEX PORT is located at the CONFIG PORT address and
the DATA PORT is at INDEX PORT address + 1.
The desired configuration registers are accessed in two steps:
a.
b.
Note:
Write the index of the Logical Device Number Configuration Register (i.e., 0x07) to the INDEX PORT
and then write the number of the desired logical device to the DATA PORT
Write the address of the desired configuration register within the logical device to the INDEX PORT
and then write or read the configuration register through the DATA PORT.
If accessing the Global Configuration Registers, step (a) is not required.
19.2.3 Exit Configuration Mode
To exit the Configuration State the system writes 0xAA to the CONFIG PORT. The chip returns to the
RUN State.
Note:
Only two states are defined (Run and Configuration). In the Run State the chip will always be ready to
enter the Configuration State.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 122
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
19.2.4 Programming Example
The following is an example of a configuration program in Intel 8086 assembly language.
;--------------------------------------------------.
; ENTER CONFIGURATION MODE |
;--------------------------------------------------'
MOV
DX,3F0H
MOV
AX,055H
OUT
DX,AL
;--------------------------------------------------.
; CONFIGURE REGISTER CRE0,
|
; LOGICAL DEVICE 8
|
;--------------------------------------------------'
MOV
DX,3F0H
MOV
AL,07H
OUT
DX,AL ; Point to LD# Config Reg
MOV
DX,3F1H
MOV
AL, 08H
OUT
DX,AL ; Point to Logical Device 8
;
MOV
DX,3F0H
MOV
AL,E0H
OUT
DX,AL ; Point to CRE0
MOV
DX,3F1H
MOV
AL,02H
OUT
DX,AL ; Update CRE0
;-------------------------------------------------.
; EXIT CONFIGURATION MODE |
;-------------------------------------------------'
MOV
DX,3F0H
MOV
AX,0AAH
OUT
DX,AL
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
HARD RESET: RESET_DRV pin asserted
SOFT RESET: Bit 0 of Configuration Control register set to one
All host accesses are blocked for 500µs after Vcc POR (see Power-up Timing Diagram)
Table 19.1 - Configuration Registers
INDEX
TYPE
0x02
0x03
0x07
0x20
0x21
0x22
0x23
0x24
0x26
W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0x27
R/W
SMSC FDC37C672
HARD RESET
VCC POR
SOFT RESET
CONFIGURATION REGISTER
GLOBAL CONFIGURATION REGISTERS
0x00
Config Control
0x03
Index Address
0x00
0x00
Logical Device Number
0x40
Device ID - hard wired
Current Revision
Device Rev - hard wired
0x00
0x00
Power Control
0x00
Power Mgmt
0x04
OSC
Sysopt=0: 0xF0
Configuration Port Address Byte 0
Sysopt=1: 0x70
Sysopt=0: 0x03
Configuration Port Address Byte 1
Sysopt=1: 0x03
Page 123
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
INDEX
0x2B
0x2C
0x2D
0x2E
0x2F
TYPE
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0x30
0x60,
0x61
0x70
0x74
0xF0
0xF1
0xF2
0xF4
0xF5
R/W
R/W
0x30
0x60,
0x61
0x70
0x74
0xF0
0xF1
R/W
R/W
0x30
0x60,
0x61
0x70
0xF0
R/W
R/W
0x30
0x60,
0x61
0x62,
0x63
0x70
0x74
0xF0
0xF1
0xF2
R/W
R/W
0x30
0x70
R/W
R/W
SMSC FDC37C672
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
HARD RESET
VCC POR
SOFT RESET
CONFIGURATION REGISTER
0x00
TEST 4
0x00
TEST 5
0x00
TEST 1
0x00
TEST 2
0x00
TEST 3
LOGICAL DEVICE 0 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (FDD)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x03,
0x03,0xF0
Primary Base I/O Address
0xF0
0x06
0x06
Primary Interrupt Select
0x02
0x02
DMA Channel Select
0x0E
FDD Mode Register
0x00
FDD Option Register
0xFF
FDD Type Register
0x00
FDD0
0x00
FDD1
LOGICAL DEVICE 1 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (RESERVED)
LOGICAL DEVICE 2 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (RESERVED)
LOGICAL DEVICE 3 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Parallel Port)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x00,
0x00,0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x00
0x00
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0x04
0x04
DMA Channel Select
0x3C
Parallel Port Mode Register
0x00
Parallel Port Mode Register 2
LOGICAL DEVICE 4 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Serial Port 1)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x00,
0x00,0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x00
0x00
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0x00
Serial Port 1 Mode Register
LOGICAL DEVICE 5 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Serial Port 2)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x00,
0x00,0x00
Primary Base I/O Address
0x00
0x00,
0x00,0x00
Fast IR Base I/O Address
0x00
0x00
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
0x04
0x04
DMA Channel Select
0x00
Serial Port 2 Mode Register
0x02
IR Options Register
0x03
IR Half Duplex Timeout
LOGICAL DEVICE 6 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (RESERVED)
LOGICAL DEVICE 7 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Keyboard)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x00
0x00
Primary Interrupt Select
Page 124
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
INDEX
0x72
0xF0
TYPE
R/W
R/W
0x30
0xB4
0xB5
0xB6
0xB7
0xC0
0xC1
0xC2
0xC3
0xC4
0xF1
0xF2
0xF3
0xF4
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note 19.3
0xF6 : FB
HARD RESET
VCC POR
SOFT RESET
CONFIGURATION REGISTER
0x00
0x00
Second Interrupt Select
0x00
KRESET and GateA20 Select
LOGICAL DEVICE 8 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (Aux I/O)
0x00
0x00
Activate
0x00
SMI Enable Register 1
0x00
SMI Enable Register 2
0x00
SMI Status Register 1
0x00
SMI Status Register 2
0x06
Pin Multiplex Controls
0x03
Force Disk Change
Floppy Data Rate Select Shadow
UART1 FIFO Control Shadow
UART2 FIFO Control Shadow
0x00
WDT_TIME_OUT
0x00
WDT_VAL
0x00
WDT_CFG
0x00
WDT_CTRL
Reserved
LOGICAL DEVICE 9 CONFIGURATION REGISTERS (RESERVED)
Note 19.3 This register contains some bits which are read or write only.
19.2.5 Chip Level (Global) Control/Configuration Registers [0x00-0x2F]
The chip-level (global) registers lie in the address range [0x00-0x2F]. The design MUST use all 8 bits of
the ADDRESS Port for register selection. All unimplemented registers and bits ignore writes and return
zero when read.
The INDEX PORT is used to select a configuration register in the chip. The DATA PORT is then used to
access the selected register. These registers are accessible only in the Configuration Mode.
Table 19.2 - Chip Level Registers
REGISTER
Config Control
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
SMSC FDC37C672
ADDRESS
0x00 -0x01
0x02 W
DESCRIPTION
Chip (Global) Control Registers
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
The hardware automatically clears this bit after the write,
there is no need for software to clear the bits.
Bit 0 = 1: Soft Reset. Refer to the "Configuration
Registers" table for the soft reset value for each register.
Page 125
DATASHEET
STATE
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
REGISTER
Index Address
ADDRESS
0x03 R/W
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0x04 - 0x06
Logical Device #
0x07 R/W
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
Card Level Reserved
0x08 - 0x1F
0x20 R
Hard wired
= 0x40
Device Rev
0x21 R
Default = 0x00.
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv hardware
signal
SMSC FDC37C672
STATE
Bits[1:0]
Sets GP index register address when in Run mode (not in
Configuration Mode).
= 11 0xEA (Default)
= 10 0xE4
= 01 0xE2
= 00 0xE0
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
A write to this register selects the current logical device.
This allows access to the control and configuration
registers for each logical device.
C
Note: The Activate command operates only on the
selected logical device.
Device ID
Hard wired
= 0x01
PowerControl
DESCRIPTION
Bit[7]
= 1 Enable WDT_CTRL and SMI Enable and SMI Status
Register access when not in configuration mode
= 0 Disable WDT_CTRL and SMI Enable and SMI
Status Register access when not in configuration
mode (Default)
Bits [6:2]
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
0x22 R/W
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Chip Level, SMSC Defined
A read only register which provides device identification.
Bits[7:0] = 0x40 when read.
C
A read only register which provides device revision
information. Bits[7:0] = 0x01 when read.
C
Bit[0] FDC Power
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[3] Parallel Port Power
Bit[4] Serial Port 1 Power
Bit[5] Serial Port 2 Power
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] Reserved (read as 0)
= 0 Power off or disabled
= 1 Power on or enabled
C
Page 126
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
REGISTER
Power Mgmt
ADDRESS
0x23 R/W
Default = 0x00.
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv hardware
signal
OSC
Default
=0xF0 (Sysopt=0)
=0x70 (Sysopt=1)
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
Configuration Address
Byte 1
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
Default = 0x00
on VCC POR and
Hard Reset
Chip Level
Vendor Defined
TEST 4
STATE
C
C
0x24 R/W
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit [1] PLL Control
= 0 PLL is on (backward Compatible)
= 1 PLL is off
Bits[3:2] OSC
= 01 Osc is on, BRG clock is on.
= 10 Same as above (01) case.
= 00 Osc is on, BRG Clock Enabled.
= 11 Osc is off, BRG clock is disabled.
Default = 0x04, on Vcc
POR or Reset_Drv
hardware signal.
Chip Level
Vendor Defined
Configuration Address
Byte 0
DESCRIPTION
Bit[0] FDC
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] Reserved
Bit[3] Parallel Port
Bit[4] Serial Port 1
Bit[5] Serial Port 2
Bit[6:7] Reserved (read as 0)
= 0 Intelligent Pwr Mgmt off
= 1 Intelligent Pwr Mgmt on
0x25
Bit [5:4] Reserved, set to zero
Bit [6] 16-Bit Address Qualification
= 0 12-Bit Address Qualification
= 1 16-Bit Address Qualification
Bit[7] Reserved
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
0x26
Bit[7:1] Configuration Address Bits [7:1]
Bit[0] = 0
See Note 19.4
C
0x27
Bit[7:0] Configuration Address Bits [15:8]
See Note 19.4
C
0x28
Bits[7:0] Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
0x29 -0x2A
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
0x2B R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
Default = 0x00, on Vcc
POR
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 127
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
REGISTER
TEST 5
ADDRESS
0x2C R/W
DESCRIPTION
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
STATE
C
Default = 0x00, on Vcc
POR
TEST 1
0x2D R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
Default = 0x00, on Vcc
POR
TEST 2
0x2E R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
Default = 0x00, on Vcc
POR
TEST 3
0x2F R/W
Test Modes: Reserved for SMSC. Users should not write
to this register, may produce undesired results.
C
Default = 0x00, on Vcc
POR
Note 19.4 To allow the selection of the configuration address to a user defined location, these Configuration Address
Bytes are used. There is no restriction on the address chosen, except that A0 is 0, that is, the address
must be on an even byte boundary. As soon as both bytes are changed, the configuration space is moved
to the specified location with no delay (Note: Write byte 0, then byte 1; writing CR27 changes the base
address).
The configuration address is only reset to its default address upon a Hard Reset or Vcc POR.
Note:
The default configuration address is either 3F0 or 370, as specified by the SYSOPT pin.
This change affects SMSC Mode only.
19.2.6 Logical Device Configuration/Control Registers [0x30-0xFF]
Used to access the registers that are assigned to each logical unit. This chip supports nine logical units
and has nine sets of logical device registers. The six logical devices are Floppy, Parallel, Serial 1, Serial
2, Keyboard Controller, and Auxiliary_I/O. A separate set (bank) of control and configuration registers
exists for each logical device and is selected with the Logical Device # Register (0x07).
The INDEX PORT is used to select a specific logical device register. These registers are then accessed
through the DATA PORT.
The Logical Device registers are accessible only when the device is in the Configuration State. The logical
register addresses are shown in the table below.
Table 19.3 - Logical Device Registers
LOGICAL DEVICE
REGISTER
Activate (Note 19.5)
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
(0x30)
Bits[7:1] Reserved, set to zero.
Bit[0]
= 1 Activates the logical device currently selected
through the Logical Device # register.
= 0 Logical device currently selected is inactive
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
C
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or Reset_Drv
Logical Device Control
SMSC FDC37C672
(0x31-0x37)
Page 128
DATASHEET
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
LOGICAL DEVICE
REGISTER
Logical Device Control
ADDRESS
DESCRIPTION
STATE
(0x38-0x3f)
C
Memory Base Address
I/O Base Address
(0x40-0x5F)
(0x60-0x6F)
(see Device Base I/O
Address Table)
0x60,2,... =
addr[15:8]
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or Reset_Drv
0x61,3,... =
addr[7:0]
Interrupt Select
(0x70,0x72)
Vendor Defined - Reserved - Writes are ignored,
reads return 0.
Reserved - Writes are ignored, reads return 0.
Registers 0x60 and 0x61 set the base address for
the device. If more than one base address is
required, the second base address is set by
registers 0x62 and 0x63.
Refer to Table 19.12 for the number of base
address registers used by each device.
Unused registers will ignore writes and return zero
when read.
0x70 is implemented for each logical device. Refer
to Interrupt Configuration Register description. Only
the keyboard controller uses Interrupt Select
register 0x72. Unused register (0x72) will ignore
writes and return zero when read. Interrupts default
to edge high (ISA compatible).
Defaults :
0x70 = 0x00,
on Vcc POR or Reset_Drv
C
C
C
0x72 = 0x00,
on Vcc POR or Reset_Drv
(0x71,0x73)
DMA Channel Select
(0x74,0x75)
Default = 0x04
on Vcc POR or Reset_Drv
32-Bit Memory Space
Configuration
Logical Device
(0x76-0xA8)
(0xA9-0xDF)
Logical Device Configuration
(0xE0-0xFE)
Reserved
0xFF
Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
Only 0x74 is implemented for FDC, Serial Port 2
and Parallel port. 0x75 is not implemented and
ignores writes and returns zero when read. Refer to
DMA Channel Configuration.
Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
Reserved - not implemented. These register
locations ignore writes and return zero when read.
Reserved - Vendor Defined (see SMSC defined
Logical Device Configuration Registers).
Reserved
C
C
C
C
Note 19.5 A logical device will be active and powered up according to the following equation:
DEVICE ON (ACTIVE) = (Activate Bit SET or Pwr/Control Bit SET).
The Logical device's Activate Bit and its Pwr/Control Bit are linked such that setting or clearing one sets or
clears the other. If the I/O Base Addr of the logical device is not within the Base I/O range as shown in the
Logical Device I/O map, then read or write is not valid and is ignored.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 129
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.4 - I/O Base Address Configuration Register Description
LOGICAL
DEVICE
NUMBER
0x00
LOGICAL
DEVICE
REGISTER
INDEX
FDC
0x60,0x61
BASE I/O
RANGE
(Note 19.6)
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE BOUNDARIES
0x03
Parallel
Port
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FFC]
ON 4 BYTE BOUNDARIES
(EPP Not supported)
or
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE BOUNDARIES
(all modes supported,
EPP is only available when the
base address is on an 8-byte
boundary)
0x04
Serial Port 1
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE BOUNDARIES
0x05
Serial Port 2
0x60,0x61
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE BOUNDARIES
0x06
0x07
Reserved
KYBD
0x09
Reserved
SMSC FDC37C672
0x62,0x63
[0x100:0x0FF8]
ON 8 BYTE BOUNDARIES
n/a
Not Relocatable
Fixed Base Address: 60,64
Page 130
DATASHEET
FIXED
BASE OFFSETS
+0 : SRA
+1 : SRB
+2 : DOR
+3 : TSR
+4 : MSR/DSR
+5 : FIFO
+7 : DIR/CCR
+0 : Data|ecpAfifo
+1 : Status
+2 : Control
+3 : EPP Address
+4 : EPP Data 0
+5 : EPP Data 1
+6 : EPP Data 2
+7 : EPP Data 3
+400h : cfifo|ecpDfifo|tfifo |cnfgA
+401h : cnfgB
+402h : ecr
+0 : RB/TB|LSB div
+1 : IER|MSB div
+2 : IIR/FCR
+3 : LCR
+4 : MSR
+5 : LSR
+6 : MSR
+7 : SCR
+0 : RB/TB|LSB div
+1 : IER|MSB div
+2 : IIR/FCR
+3 : LCR
+4 : MSR
+5 : LSR
+6 : MSR
+7 : SCR
+0 : Fast IR Registers
+1 : Fast IR Registers
+2 : Fast IR Registers
+3 : Fast IR Registers
+4 : Fast IR Registers
+5 : Fast IR Registers
+6 : Fast IR Registers
+7 : Fast IR Registers
+0 : Data Register
+4 : Command/Status Reg.
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Note 19.6 This chip uses ISA address bits [A11:A0] to decode the base address of each of its logical devices.
Table 19.5 - Interrupt Select Configuration Register Description
NAME
Interrupt Request
Level
Select 0
REG INDEX
0x70 (R/W)
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
DEFINITION
Bits[3:0] selects which interrupt level is used for Interrupt 0.
0x00= no interrupt selected.
0x01= IRQ1
0x02= IRQ2/nSMI
0x03= IRQ3
0x04= IRQ4
0x05= IRQ6
0x06= IRQ7
0x07= IRQ7
0x08= IRQ8
0x09= IRQ9
0x0A= IRQ10
0x0B= IRQ11
0x0C= IRQ12
0x0D= IRQ13
0x0E= IRQ14
0x0F= IRQ15
STATE
C
Notes:
All interrupts are edge high (except ECP/EPP)
nSMI is active low
Notes:
An Interrupt is activated by setting the Interrupt Request Level Select 0 register to a non-zero value AND:
for the FDC logical device by setting DMAEN, bit D3 of the Digital Output Register.
for the PP logical device by setting IRQE, bit D4 of the Control Port and in addition
for the PP logical device in ECP mode by clearing serviceIntr, bit D2 of the ecr.
for the Serial Port logical device by setting any combination of bits D0-D3 in the IER
and by setting the OUT2 bit in the UART's Modem Control (MCR) Register.
for the RTC by (refer to the RTC section of this spec.)
for the KYBD by (refer to the KYBD controller section of this spec.)
IRQ pins must tri-state if not used/selected by any Logical Device. Refer to Section 19.2.7 - Note A. Logical
Device IRQ and DMA Operation.
nSMI must be disabled to use IRQ2.
All IRQ’s are available in Serial IRQ mode. Only IRQ[3:7] and IRQ[10:12] are available in Parallel IRQ mode.
Table 19.6 - DMA Channel Select Configuration Register Description
NAME
DMA Channel
Select
Default = 0x04
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
SMSC FDC37C672
REG INDEX
0x74 (R/W)
DEFINITION
Bits[2:0] select the DMA Channel.
0x00= Reserved
0x01= DMA1
0x02= DMA2
0x03= DMA3
0x04-0x07= No DMA active
Page 131
DATASHEET
STATE
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Notes:
A DMA channel is activated by setting the DMA Channel Select register to [0x01-0x03] AND :
for the FDC logical device by setting DMAEN, bit D3 of the Digital Output Register.
for the PP logical device in ECP mode by setting dmaEn, bit D3 of the ecr.
for the UART 2 logical device, by setting the DMA Enable bit. Refer to the IRCC specification.
DMAREQ pins must tri-state if not used/selected by any Logical Device. Refer to Section 19.2.7 - Note A. Logical
Device IRQ and DMA Operation.
19.2.7 Note A. Logical Device IRQ and DMA Operation
1.
IRQ and DMA Enable and Disable: Any time the IRQ or DACK for a logical block is disabled by a
register bit in that logical block, the IRQ and/or DACK must be disabled. This is in addition to the IRQ
and DACK disabled by the Configuration Registers (active bit or address not valid).
a. FDC: For the following cases, the IRQ and DACK used by the FDC are disabled (high
impedance). Will not respond to the DREQ
Digital Output Register (Base+2) bit D3 (DMAEN) set to "0".
The FDC is in power down (disabled).
b. Serial Port 1 and 2:
Modem Control Register (MCR) Bit D2 (OUT2) - When OUT2 is a logic "0", the serial port
interrupt is forced to a high impedance state - disabled.
c. Parallel Port:
i. SPP and EPP modes: Control Port (Base+2) bit D4 (IRQE) set to "0", IRQ is disabled (high
impedance).
ii. ECP Mode:
(1) (DMA) dmaEn from ecr register. See table.
(2) IRQ - See table.
MODE
IRQ PIN
PDREQ PIN
(FROM ECR REGISTER)
CONTROLLED BY CONTROLLED BY
000
PRINTER
IRQE
dmaEn
001
SPP
IRQE
dmaEn
010
FIFO
(on)
dmaEn
011
ECP
(on)
dmaEn
100
EPP
IRQE
dmaEn
101
RES
IRQE
dmaEn
110
TEST
(on)
dmaEn
111
CONFIG
IRQE
dmaEn
d. Keyboard Controller: Refer to the KBD section of this spec.
19.2.8 SMSC Defined Logical Device Configuration Registers
The SMSC Specific Logical Device Configuration
Registers reset to their default values only on hard resets generated by Vcc or VTR POR (as shown) or
the RESET_DRV signal. These registers are not affected by soft resets.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 132
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.7 - Floppy Disk Controller, Logical Device 0 [Logical Device Number = 0x00]
NAME
FDD Mode Register
REG INDEX
0xF0 R/W
Default = 0x0E
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
DEFINITION
Bit[0] Floppy Mode
= 0 Normal Floppy Mode (default)
= 1 Enhanced Floppy Mode 2 (OS2)
Bit[1] FDC DMA Mode
= 0 Burst Mode is enabled
= 1 Non-Burst Mode (default)
Bit[3:2] Interface Mode
= 11 AT Mode (default)
= 10 (Reserved)
= 01 PS/2
= 00 Model 30
Bit[4] Swap Drives 0,1 Mode
= 0 No swap (default)
= 1 Drive and Motor sel 0 and 1 are swapped.
Bit[5] Reserved, set to zero
Bit[6] FDC Output Type Control
= 0 FDC outputs are OD24 open drain (default)
= 1 FDC outputs are O24 push-pull
Bit[7] FDC Output Control
= 0 FDC outputs active (default)
= 1 FDC outputs tri-stated
STATE
C
Note: Bits 6 & 7 do not affect the parallel port FDC pins.
FDD Option Register
0xF1 R/W
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
FDD Type Register
0xF2 R/W
Default = 0xFF
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
Bits[1:0] Reserved, set to zero
Bits[3:2] Density Select
= 00 Normal (default)
= 01 Normal (reserved for users)
= 10 1 (forced to logic "1")
= 11 0 (forced to logic "0")
Bit[4] Media ID 0 Polarity
= 0: Don’t invert (default)
= 1: Invert
Bit[5] Media ID 1 Polarity
= 0: Don’t invert (default)
= 1: Invert
Bits[7:6] Boot Floppy
= 00 FDD 0 (default)
= 01 FDD 1
= 10 Reserved (neither drive A or B is a boot drive).
= 11 Reserved (neither drive A or B is a boot drive).
Bits[1:0] Floppy Drive A Type
Bits[3:2] Floppy Drive B Type
Bits[5:4] Reserved (could be used to store Floppy Drive C
type)
Bits[7:6] Reserved (could be used to store Floppy Drive D
type)
C
C
Note: The FDC37C672 supports two floppy drives
0xF3 R
SMSC FDC37C672
Reserved, Read as 0 (read only)
Page 133
DATASHEET
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
NAME
REG INDEX
0xF4 R/W
FDD0
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
FDD1
0xF5 R/W
DEFINITION
Bits[1:0] Drive Type Select: DT1, DT0
Bits[2] Read as 0 (read only)
Bits[4:3] Data Rate Table Select: DRT1, DRT0
Bits[5] Read as 0 (read only)
Bits[6] Precompensation Disable PTS
=0
Use Precompensation
=1
No Precompensation
Bits[7] Read as 0 (read only)
Refer to definition and default for 0xF4
STATE
C
C
Table 19.8 - Parallel Port, Logical Device 3 [Logical Device Number = 0x03]
NAME
PP Mode Register
REG INDEX
0xF0 R/W
Default = 0x3C
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
DEFINITION
Bits[2:0] Parallel Port Mode
= 100 Printer Mode (default)
= 000 Standard and Bi-directional (SPP) Mode
= 001 EPP-1.9 and SPP Mode
= 101 EPP-1.7 and SPP Mode
= 010 ECP Mode
= 011 ECP and EPP-1.9 Mode
= 111 ECP and EPP-1.7 Mode
STATE
C
Bit[6:3] ECP FIFO Threshold
0111b (default)
Bit[7] PP Interrupt Type
Not valid when the parallel port is in the Printer Mode
(100) or the Standard & Bi-directional Mode (000).
=1
Pulsed Low, released to high-Z.
=0
IRQ follows nACK when parallel port in EPP Mode or
[Printer,SPP, EPP] under ECP.
PP Mode Register 2
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1 R/W
IRQ level type when the parallel port is in ECP, TEST, or
Centronics FIFO Mode.
Bits[1:0] PPFDC - muxed PP/FDC control
= 00 Normal Parallel Port Mode
= 01 PPFD1: Drive 0 is on the FDC pins
Drive 1 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 2 is on the FDC pins
Drive 3 is on the FDC pins
= 10 PPFD2: Drive 0 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 1 is on the Parallel port pins
Drive 2 is on the FDC pins
Drive 3 is on the FDC pins
Bits[7:2] Reserved. Set to zero.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 134
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.9 - Serial Port 1, Logical Device 4 [Logical Device Number = 0x04]
NAME
Serial Port 1
Mode Register
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
REG INDEX
0xF0 R/W
DEFINITION
Bit[0] MIDI Mode
= 0 MIDI support disabled (default)
= 1 MIDI support enabled
STATE
C
Bit[1] High Speed
= 0 High Speed Disabled(default)
= 1 High Speed Enabled
Bit[6:2] Reserved, set to zero
Bit[7]: Share IRQ
=0
UARTS use different IRQs
=1
UARTS share a common IRQ
See Note 19.7 below.
Note 19.7 To properly share and IRQ,
1. Configure UART1 (or UART2) to use the desired IRQ pin.
2. Configure UART2 (or UART1) to use No IRQ selected.
3. Set the share IRQ bit.
Note: If both UARTs are configured to use different IRQ pins and the share IRQ bit is set, then both of the
UART IRQ pins will assert when either UART generates an interrupt.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 135
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.10 - Serial Port 2, Logical Device 5 [Logical Device Number = 0x05]
NAME
Serial Port 2
Mode Register
REG INDEX
0xF0 R/W
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
IR Option Register
0xF1 R/W
Default = 0x02
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
IR Half Duplex Timeout
Default = 0x03
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
SMSC FDC37C672
0xF2
DEFINITION
Bit[0] MIDI Mode
= 0 MIDI support disabled (default)
= 1 MIDI support enabled
Bit[1] High Speed
= 0 High Speed disabled(default)
= 1 High Speed enabled
Bit[7:2] Reserved, set to zero
Bit[0] Receive Polarity
=0
Active High (Default)
=1
Active Low
Bit[1] Transmit Polarity
=0
Active High
=1
Active Low (Default)
Bit[2] Duplex Select
=0
Full Duplex (Default)
=1
Half Duplex
Bits[5:3] IR Mode
= 000 Standard (Default)
= 001 IrDA
= 010 ASK-IR
= 011 Reserved
= 1xx Reserved
Bit[6] IR Location Mux
=0
Use Serial port TX2 and RX2 (Default)
=1
Use alternate IRRX (pin 61) and IRTX (pin 62)
Bit[7] Reserved, write 0.
Bits [7:0]
These bits set the half duplex time-out for the IR port. This
value is 0 to 10msec in 100usec increments.
0= blank during transmit/receive
1= blank during transmit/receive + 100usec
...
Page 136
DATASHEET
STATE
C
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.11 - KYBD, Logical Device 7 [Logical Device Number = 0x07]
NAME
KRST_GA20
REG INDEX
0xF0
R/W
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
0xF1 0xFF
DEFINITION
KRESET and GateA20 Select
Bit[7] Polarity Select for P12
= 0 P12 active low (default)
= 1 P12 active high
Bits[6:3] Reserved
Bit[2] Port 92 Select
= 0 Port 92 Disabled
= 1 Port 92 Enabled
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[0] Reserved
Reserved - read as ‘0’
STATE
Table 19.12 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08]
NAME
SMI Enable Register
1
REG INDEX
0xB4 R/W
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR
SMI Enable Register
2
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR
0xB5 R/W
DEFINITION
This register is used to enable the different interrupt sources
onto the group nSMI output.
1=Enable
0=Disable
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit[1] EN_PINT
Bit[2] EN_U2INT
Bit[3] EN_U1INT
Bit[4] EN_FINT
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] EN_WDT
This register is used to enable the different interrupt sources
onto the group nSMI output, and the group nSMI output
onto the nSMI GPI/O pin.
STATE
C
C
Unless otherwise noted,
1=Enable
0=Disable
Bit[0] EN_MINT
Bit[1] EN_KINT
Bit[2] EN_IRINT
Bit[3] Reserved
Bit[4] EN_P12: Enable 8042 P1.2 to route internally to
nSMI. 0=Do not route to nSMI, 1=Enable routing to nSMI.
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] EN_SMI_S: Enables nSMI Interrupt onto Serial IRQ.
Bit[7] EN_SMI_P: Enables nSMI Interrupt onto Parallel
Interrupt Pin IRQ10. 0=SMI pin floats, 1=Output onto nSMI
GPI/O pin.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 137
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
NAME
SMI Status Register 1
REG INDEX
0xB6 R/W
DEFINITION
This register is used to read the status of the SMI inputs.
STATE
C
0xB7 R/W
The following bits must be cleared at their source.
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit[1] PINT (Parallel Port Interrupt)
Bit[2] U2INT (UART 2 Interrupt)
Bit[3] U1INT (UART 1 Interrupt)
Bit[4] FINT (Floppy Disk Controller Interrupt)
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] Reserved
Bit[7] WDT (Watch Dog Timer)
This register is used to read the status of the SMI inputs.
Bit[0] MINT: Mouse Interrupt. Cleared at source.
Bit[1] KINT: Keyboard Interrupt. Cleared at source.
Bit[2] IRINT: This bit is set by a transition on the IR pin
(RDX2 or IRRX as selected in CR L5-F1-B6 i.e., after the
MUX). Cleared by a read of this register.
Bit[3] Reserved
Bit[4] P12: 8042 P1.2. Cleared at source
Bit[7:5] Reserved
Bits[7:0] Reserved
C
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR
SMI Status Register 2
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR
Default = 0x00
on VTR POR
Pin Multiplex Controls
0xB8 R/W
0xC0
Default = 0x06 on Vcc
POR
Force Disk Change
Default = 0x03 on Vcc
POR
0xC1
(R/W)
Bit[0] IR Mode Select
Bit[1] DMA 3 Select
Bit[2] Serial IRQ Select
Bit[3] 8042 Select
Bit[4] IRRX 3 Select
Bit[5:7] Reserved
Bit[0] Force Change 0
Bit[1] Force Change 1
Bit[7:2] Reserved
C
C,R
Force Change[1:0] can be written to 1 but are not clearable
by software.
Force Change 1 is cleared on nSTEP and nDS1 Force
Change 0 is cleared on nSTEP and nDS0
Floppy Data Rate
Select Shadow
SMSC FDC37C672
0xC2
(R)
DSKCHG (FDC DIR Register, Bit 7) = (nDS0 AND Force
Change 0) OR (nDS1 AND Force Change 1) OR nDSKCHG
Bit[0] Data Rate Select 0
Bit[1] Data Rate Select 1
Bit[2] PRECOMP 0
Bit[3] PRECOMP 1
Bit[4] PRECOMP 2
Bit[5] Reserved
Bit[6] Power Down
Bit[7] Soft Reset
Page 138
DATASHEET
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
NAME
UART1 FIFO Control
Shadow
REG INDEX
0xC3
UART2 FIFO Control
Shadow
0xC4
DEFINITION
Bit[0] FIFO Enable
Bit[1] RCVR FIFO Reset
Bit[2] XMIT FIFO Reset
Bit[3] DMA Mode Select
Bit[5:4] Reserved
Bit[6] RCVR Trigger (LSB)
Bit[7] RCVR Trigger (MSB)
Bit[0] FIFO Enable
Bit[1] RCVR FIFO Reset
Bit[2] XMIT FIFO Reset
Bit[3] DMA Mode Select
Bit[5:4] Reserved
Bit[6] RCVR Trigger (LSB)
Bit[7] RCVR Trigger (MSB)
STATE
C
C
Table 19.13 - nRTS MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
16 BIT ADDRESS QUAL.
(CR24.6)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
SELECTED FUNCTION
nRTS2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
nRTS2 (default)
IRQ5
SA12
Reserved
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
0
-
Table 19.14 - nCTS2 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
16 BIT ADDRESS
QUAL. (CR24.6)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
SELECTED FUNCTION
nCTS2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
nCTS2 (default)
IRQ6
SA13
Reserved
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
1
0
-
Table 19.15 - nDTR2 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
16 BIT ADDRESS
QUAL. (CR24.6)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
SELECTED FUNCTION
nDTR2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
nDTR2 (default)
IRQ7
SA14
Reserved
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 139
DATASHEET
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
0
-
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.16 - nDSR2 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
16 BIT ADDRESS
QUAL. (CR24.6)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
nDSR2
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
SELECTED FUNCTION
nDSR2 (default)
IRQ10
(Note 19.8)
SA15
Reserved
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
1
0
-
Note 19.8 LD8:CRB5.7 controls the IRQ10/nSMI interrupt mux.
Table 19.17 - nDCD2 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
8042COMSEL.
(LD8:CRC0.3)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
SELECTED FUNCTION
nDCD2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
nDCD2 (default)
IRQ11
P12
Reserved
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
1
-
Table 19.18 - nRI2 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN
NAME
8042COMSEL.
(LD8:CRC0.3)
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
SELECTED FUNCTION
nRI2
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
nRI2 (default)
IRQ12
P16
Reserved
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
1
-
Table 19.19 - DRQ3 MUXING
PIN NAME
DRQ3
SMSC FDC37C672
MUX CONTROL
DMA3SEL
(LD8:CRC0.1)
1
0
SELECTED FUNCTION
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
DRQ3 (default)
P12
-
Page 140
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 19.20 - nDACK3 MUXING
MUX CONTROL
DMA3SEL
(LD8:CRC0.1)
1
0
PIN NAME
nDACK3
SELECTED FUNCTION
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
nDACK3 (default)
P16
1
-
Table 19.21 - SER_IRQ MUXING
MUX CONTROL
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
1
0
PIN NAME
SER_IRQ
SELECTED FUNCTION
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
SER_IRQ (default)
IRQ3
1
-
Table 19.22 - PCI_CLK MUXING
MUX CONTROL
SERIRQSEL
(LD8:CRC0.2)
1
0
PIN NAME
PCI_CLK
SELECTED FUNCTION
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
PCI_CLK (default)
IRQ4
1
-
Table 19.23 - DRVDEN1 MUXING
MUX CONTROLS
PIN NAME
DRVDEN1
IRMODESEL
(LD8:CRC0.0)
IRRX3SEL
(LD8:CRC0.4)
SELECTED
FUNCTION
0
1
0
1
1
DRVDEN1 (default)
IRMODE
(Note 19.9)
IRRX3
STATE OF
UNCONNECTED
INPUTS
0
Note 19.9 IRRX3SEL Default (0).
Table 19.24 - Auxiliary I/O, Logical Device 8 [Logical Device Number = 0x08]
NAME
WDT_TIME_OUT
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
SMSC FDC37C672
REG INDEX
0xF1
DEFINITION
Bit[0] Reserved
Bit[1] Reserved
Bits[6:2] Reserved, = 00000
Bit[7] WDT Time-out Value Units Select
= 0 Minutes (default)
= 1 Seconds
Page 141
DATASHEET
STATE
C
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
NAME
WDT_VAL
REG INDEX
0xF2
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
WDT_CFG
0xF3
Default = 0x00
on Vcc POR or
Reset_Drv
WDT_CTRL
Default = 0x00
Cleared by VTR POR
0xF4
DEFINITION
Watch-dog Timer Time-out Value
Binary coded, units = minutes(default) or seconds, selectable
via Bit[7] of Reg 0xF1, LD 8.
0x00 Time out disabled
0x01 Time-out = 1 minute (second)
0xFF Time-out = 255 minutes (seconds)
Watch-dog timer Configuration
Bit[0] Joy-stick Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon an I/O read or write of the Game
Port
=0
WDT is not affected by I/O reads or writes to the Game
Port.
Bit[1] Keyboard Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon a Keyboard interrupt.
=0
WDT is not affected by Keyboard interrupts.
Bit[2] Mouse Enable
=1
WDT is reset upon a Mouse interrupt
=0
WDT is not affected by Mouse interrupts.
Bit[3] Reserved
Bits[7:4] WDT Interrupt Mapping
1111 = IRQ15
0011 = IRQ3
0010 = Invalid
0001 = IRQ1
0000 = Disable
Watch-dog timer Control
Bit[0] Watch-dog Status Bit, R/W
=1
WD timeout occurred
=0
WD timer counting
Bit[1] Reserved
Bit[2] Force Timeout, W
=1
Forces WD timeout event; this bit is self-clearing
Bit[3] P20 Force Timeout Enable, R/W
= 1 Allows rising edge of P20, from the Keyboard
Controller, to force the WD timeout event. A WD
timeout event may still be forced by setting the Force
Timeout Bit, bit 2.
= 0 P20 activity does not generate the WD timeout event.
STATE
C
C
C
Note: The P20 signal will remain high for a minimum of 1us
and can remain high indefinitely. Therefore, when P20
forced timeouts are enabled, a self-clearing edgedetect circuit is used to generate a signal which is
ORed with the signal generated by the Force Timeout
Bit.
Bit[7:4] Reserved. Set to 0
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 142
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 20 Operational Description
20.1
Maximum Guaranteed Ratings*
Operating Temperature Range .................................................................................................. 0oC to +70oC
Storage Temperature Range .................................................................................................. -55o to +150oC
Lead Temperature Range (soldering, 10 seconds)............................................................................. +325oC
Positive Voltage on any pin, with respect to Ground.........................................................................Vcc+0.3V
Negative Voltage on any pin, with respect to Ground ............................................................................ -0.3V
Maximum Vcc............................................................................................................................................ +7V
*Stresses above those listed above could cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating
only and functional operation of the device at any other condition above those indicated in the operation
sections of this specification is not implied.
Note:
When powering this device from laboratory or system power supplies, it is important that the Absolute
Maximum Ratings not be exceeded or device failure can result. Some power supplies exhibit voltage
spikes on their outputs when the AC power is switched on or off. In addition, voltage transients on the AC
power line may appear on the DC output. If this possibility exists, it is suggested that a clamp circuit be
used.
20.2
DC Electrical Characteristics
(TA = 0°C - 70°C, Vcc = +5 V ± 10%)
PARAMETER
I Type Input Buffer
SYMBOL
Low Input Level
VILI
High Input Level
IS Type Input Buffer
VIHI
Low Input Level
VILIS
High Input Level
VIHIS
Schmitt Trigger Hysteresis
ICLK Input Buffer
VHYS
Low Input Level
VILCK
High Input Level
ICLK2 Input Buffer
VIHCK
MIN
MAX
UNITS
0.8
V
COMMENTS
TTL Levels
V
2.0
0.8
2.2
V
Schmitt Trigger
V
Schmitt Trigger
mV
250
0.4
V
V
2.2
Input Level
SMSC FDC37C672
TYP
500
Page 143
DATASHEET
mV
VP-P
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PARAMETER
Input Leakage
(All I and IS buffers)
SYMBOL
MIN
Low Input Leakage
IIL
-10
High Input Leakage
IIH
-10
VBAT
IBAT
2.4
Standby Current
Input Leakage
O4 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
VOL
High Output Level
VOH
2.4
Output Leakage
IOL
-10
TYP
3.0
250
MAX
UNITS
COMMENTS
+10
µA
VIN = 0
+10
µA
V
nA
nA
VIN = VCC
4.0
1000
100
0.4
V
IOL = 4 mA
V
IOH = -2 mA
+10
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
0.4
V
IOL = 8 mA
V
IOH = -8 mA
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
VCC=VSS=0
VCC=5V, VBAT=3V
O8SR Type Buffer
Low Output Level
VOL
High Output Level
VOH
2.4
Output Leakage
IOL
-10
Rise Time
TRT
5
ns
Fall Time
TFL
5
ns
+10
O24 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
VOL
High Output Level
VOH
2.4
Output Leakage
IOL
-10
V
IOL = 24 mA
V
IOH = -12 mA
+10
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
0.4
V
IOL = 16 mA
V
IOH = -16 mA
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
0.4
O16SR Type Buffer
Low Output Level
VOL
High Output Level
VOH
2.4
Output Leakage
IOL
-10
Rise Time
TRT
5
ns
Fall Time
TFL
5
ns
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 144
DATASHEET
+10
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PARAMETER
OD16P Type Buffer
SYMBOL
Low Output Level
VOL
Output Leakage
IOL
MIN
TYP
-10
MAX
UNITS
0.4
V
+10
µA
COMMENTS
IOL = 16 mA
IOH = 90 µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
OD24 Type Buffer
Low Output Level
VOL
0.4
V
IOL = 24 mA
Output Leakage
IOL
+10
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
Low Output Level
VOL
0.4
V
IOL = 48 mA
Output Leakage
IOL
+10
µA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
Low Output Level
VOL
0.4
V
IOL = 2 mA
High Output Level
VOH
3.5
V
IOH = -2 mA
Output Leakage
IOL
-10
+10
µA
ChiProtect
IIL
± 10
µA
IIL
± 10
µA
IIL
± 10
µA
90
mA
VIN = 0 to VCC
(Note 20.1)
VCC = 0V
VIN = 6V Max
VCC = 0V
VIN = 6V Max
VCC = 0V
VIN = 6V Max
All outputs open.
OD48 Type Buffer
OCLK2 Type Buffer
(SLCT, PE, BUSY, nACK, nERROR)
Backdrive
(nSTROBE, nAUTOFD, nINIT, nSLCTIN)
Backdrive
(PD0-PD7)
Supply Current Active
ICCI
4.5
70
Note 20.1 All output leakages are measured with the current pins in high impedance
Note 20.2 Output leakage is measured with the low driving output off, either for a high level output or a high
impedance state.
Note 20.3 KBCLK, KBDATA, MCLK, MDATA contain 90uA min pull-ups.
CAPACITANCE TA = 25°C; fc = 1MHz; VCC = 5V
PARAMETER
Clock Input Capacitance
Input Capacitance
Output Capacitance
SMSC FDC37C672
SYMBOL
CIN
CIN
COUT
MIN
LIMITS
TYP
MAX
20
10
20
Page 145
DATASHEET
UNIT
pF
pF
pF
TEST CONDITION
All pins except pin
under test tied to AC
ground
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 21 Timing Diagrams
For the Timing Diagrams shown, the following capacitive loads are used.
NAME
SD[0:7]
IOCHRDY
IRQ[3:7,10:12]
DRQ[1:3]
nWGATE
nWDATA
nHDSEL
nDIR
nSTEP
nDS[1:0]
nMTR[1:0]
DRVDEN[1:0]
TXD1
nRTS1
nDTR1
TXD2
nRTS2
nDTR2
PD[0:7]
nSLCTIN
nINIT
nALF
nSTB
KDAT
KCLK
MDAT
MCLK
SMSC FDC37C672
CAPACITANCE
TOTAL (PF)
240
240
120
120
240
240
240
240
240
240
240
240
100
100
100
100
100
100
240
240
240
240
240
240
240
240
240
Page 146
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t3
SAx
t4
SD<7:0>
t1
t2
nIOW
t5
Figure 21.1 - IOW Timing for Port 92
IOW TIMING
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
DESCRIPTION
SAx Valid to nIOW Asserted
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
nIOW Asserted to SAx Invalid
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
MIN
40
0
10
0
100
t1
TYP
MAX
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
t2
V cc
t3
A ll H o s t
A ccesses
Figure 21.2 - Power-Up Timing
NAME
DESCRIPTION
MIN
TYP
MAX
UNITS
t1
Vcc Slew from 4.5V to 0V
300
µs
t2
Vcc Slew from 0V to 4.5V
100
µs
t3
All Host Accesses After Powerup (Note 21.1)
125
500
µs
Note 21.1 Internal write-protection period after Vcc passes 4.5 volts on power-up
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 147
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t10
AEN
t3
SA[x], nCS
t2
nIOW
SD[x]
t1
t4
t6
t5
DATA VALID
t7
FINTR
t8
PINTR
t9
IBF
Figure 21.3 - ISA Write
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
t9
t10
DESCRIPTION
SA[x], nCS and AEN valid to nIOW asserted
nIOW asserted to nIOW deasserted
nIOW asserted to SA[x], nCS invalid
SD[x] Valid to nIOW deasserted
SD[x] Hold from nIOW deasserted
nIOW deasserted to nIOW asserted
nIOW deasserted to FINTR deasserted (Note 21.2)
nIOW deasserted to PINTER deasserted (Note 21.3)
IBF (internal signal) asserted from nIOW deasserted
nIOW deasserted to AEN invalid
MIN
10
80
10
45
TYP
MAX
0
25
55
260
40
10
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 21.2 FINTR refers to the IRQ used by the floppy disk.
Note 21.3 PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 148
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t13
AEN
t3
SA[x], nCS
t1
nIOR
t7
t2
t6
t4
SD[x]
t5
DATA VALID
PD[x], nERROR,
PE, SLCT, ACK, BUSY
t10
FINTER
t9
PINTER
t11
PCOBF
t12
AUXOBF1
t8
nIOR/nIOW
Figure 21.4 - ISA Read
Table 21.1 - ISA Read Timing Parameters
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t8
t8
t7
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
DESCRIPTION
SA[x], nCS and AEN valid to nIOR asserted
nIOR asserted to nIOR deasserted
nIOR asserted to SA[x], nCS invalid
nIOR asserted to Data Valid
Data Hold/float from nIOR deasserted
nIOR deasserted
nIOR asserted after nIOW deasserted
nIOR/nIOR, nIOW/nIOW transfers from/to ECP FIFO
Parallel Port setup to nIOR asserted
nIOR asserted to PINTER deasserted
nIOR deasserted to FINTER deasserted
nIOR deasserted to PCOBF deasserted (Note 21.6, Note 21.8)
nIOR deasserted to AUXOBF1 deasserted (Note 21.7, Note 21.8)
nIOW deasserted to AEN invalid
MIN
10
50
10
10
25
80
150
TYP
MAX
50
25
20
55
260
80
80
10
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 21.4 FINTR refers to the IRQ used by the floppy disk.
Note 21.5 PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port.
Note 21.6 PCOBF is used for the Keyboard IRQ.
Note 21.7 AUXOBF1 is used for the Mouse IRQ.
Note 21.8 Applies only if deassertion is performed in hardware.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 149
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t2
PCOBF
t1
AUXOBF1
nWRT
t3
IBF
nRD
Figure 21.5 - Internal 8042 CPU Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
Note 21.9
DESCRIPTION
nWRT deasserted to AUXOBF1 asserted (Note 21.9, Note 21.10)
nWRT deasserted to PCOBF asserted (Note 21.9, Note 21.11)
nRD deasserted to IBF deasserted (Note 21.9)
MIN
TYP
MAX
40
40
40
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
IBF, nWRT and nRD are internal signals.
Note 21.10 PCOBF is used for the Keyboard IRQ.
Note 21.11 AUXOBF1 is used for the Mouse IRQ.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 150
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t1
t2
t2
CLOCKI
Figure 21.6 - Input Clock Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t1
t2
DESCRIPTION
Clock Cycle Time for 14.318MHZ
Clock High Time/Low Time for 14.318MHz
Clock Cycle Time for 32KHZ
MIN
Clock High Time/Low Time for 32KHz
TYP
70
35
31.25
MAX
µs
5
µs
ns
MAX
UNITS
16.53
Clock Rise Time/Fall Time (not shown)
UNITS
ns
ns
t4
RESET_DRV
Figure 21.7 - Reset Timing
NAME
t4
DESCRIPTION
RESET width (Note 21.12)
MIN
1.5
TYP
µs
Note 21.12 The RESET width is dependent upon the processor clock. The RESET must be active while the clock is
running and stable.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 151
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t15
AEN
t16
t3
t2
FDRQ,
PDRQ
t1
nDACK
t4
t12
t14
t11
nIOR
or
nIOW
t6
t5
t8
t10
t9
t7
DATA
(DO-D7)
DATA VALID
t13
TC
Figure 21.8 - DMA Timing (Single Transfer Mode)
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
t14
t15
t16
DESCRIPTION
nDACK Delay Time from FDRQ High
DRQ Reset Delay from nIOR or nIOW
FDRQ Reset Delay from nDACK Low
nDACK Width
nIOR Delay from FDRQ High
nIOW Delay from FDRQ High
Data Access Time from nIOR Low
Data Set Up Time to nIOW High
Data to Float Delay from nIOR High
Data Hold Time from nIOW High
nDACK Set Up to nIOW/nIOR Low
nDACK Hold after nIOW/nIOR High
TC Pulse Width
AEN Set Up to nIOR/nIOW
AEN Hold from nDACK
TC Active to PDRQ Inactive
SMSC FDC37C672
MIN
0
TYP
MAX
100
100
150
0
0
100
40
10
10
5
10
60
40
10
60
100
Page 152
DATASHEET
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t15
AEN
t16
t3
t2
FDRQ,
PDRQ
t1
t4
nDACK
t12
t14
t11
t6
nIOR
or
nIOW
t8
t5
t10
t9
t7
DATA
(DO-D7)
DATA VALID
DATA VALID
t13
TC
Figure 21.9 - DMA Timing (Burst Transfer Mode)
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
t14
t15
t16
DESCRIPTION
nDACK Delay Time from FDRQ High
DRQ Reset Delay from nIOR or nIOW
FDRQ Reset Delay from nDACK Low
nDACK Width
nIOR Delay from FDRQ High
nIOW Delay from FDRQ High
Data Access Time from nIOR Low
Data Set Up Time to nIOW High
Data to Float Delay from nIOR High
Data Hold Time from nIOW High
nDACK Set Up to nIOW/nIOR Low
nDACK Hold after nIOW/nIOR High
TC Pulse Width
AEN Set Up to nIOR/nIOW
AEN Hold from nDACK
TC Active to PDRQ Inactive
SMSC FDC37C672
MIN
0
TYP
MAX
100
100
150
0
0
100
40
10
10
5
10
60
40
10
60
100
Page 153
DATASHEET
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t3
nDIR
t4
t1
nSTEP
t2
t5
nDS0-3
t6
nINDEX
t7
nRDATA
t8
nWDATA
nIOW
nDS0-1,
MTR0-1
t9
t9
Figure 21.10 - Disk Drive Timing (At Mode Only)
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
t9
DESCRIPTION
nDIR Set Up to STEP Low
nSTEP Active Time Low
nDIR Hold Time after nSTEP
nSTEP Cycle Time
nDS0-1 Hold Time from nSTEP Low
nINDEX Pulse Width
nRDATA Active Time Low
nWDATA Write Data Width Low
nDS0-1, MTRO-1 from End of nIOW
MIN
TYP
4
24
96
132
20
2
40
.5
25
MAX
UNITS
X*
X*
X*
X*
X*
X*
ns
Y*
ns
Notes:
*X specifies one MCLK period and Y specifies one WCLK period.
MCLK = 16 x Data Rate (at 500 kb/s MCLK = 8 MHz)
WCLK = 2 x Data Rate (at 500 kb/s WCLK = 1 MHz)
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 154
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
nIOW
t1
nRTSx,
nDTRx
t5
IRQx
nCTSx,
nDSRx,
nDCDx
t6
t2
t4
IRQx
nIOW
t3
IRQx
nIOR
nRIx
Figure 21.11 - Serial Port Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
nRTSx, nDTRx Delay from nIOW
IRQx Active Delay from nCTSx, nDSRx, nDCDx
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOR (Leading Edge)
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOW (Trailing Edge)
IRQx Inactive Delay from nIOW
IRQx Active Delay from nRIx
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 155
DATASHEET
MIN
10
TYP
MAX
200
100
120
125
100
100
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
PD0- PD7
t6
nIOW
t1
nINIT, nSTROBE.
nAUTOFD, SLCTIN
nACK
nPINTR
(SPP)
t2
t4
PINTR
(ECP or EPP Enabled)
t3
nFAULT (ECP)
nERROR
(ECP)
t5
t2
PINTR
t3
Figure 21.12 - Parallel Port Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
Note:
DESCRIPTION
PD0-7, nINIT, nSTROBE, nAUTOFD Delay from nIOW
PINTR Delay from nACK, nFAULT
PINTR Active Low in ECP and EPP Modes
PINTR Delay from nACK
nERROR Active to PINTR Active
PD0 - PD7 Delay from IOW Active
MIN
200
TYP
MAX
100
60
300
105
105
100
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
PINTR refers to the IRQ used by the parallel port.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 156
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t18
A0-A10
t9
SD<7:0>
t17
t8
nIOW
t12
t10
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
t19
t11
t13
t22
t20
t2
t1
t5
PD<7:0>
t14
nDATAST
t16
t3
t4
nADDRSTB
t6
t15
t7
nWAIT
PDIR
t21
Figure 21.13 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Write Cycle
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 157
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 21.2 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Cycle Timing Parameters
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
nIOW Asserted to PDATA Valid
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Change (Note 21.13)
nWRITE to Command Asserted
nWAIT Deasserted to Command Deasserted (Note 21.13)
nWAIT Asserted to PDATA Invalid (Note 21.13)
Time Out
MIN
0
60
5
60
0
10
t7
t8
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
t14
t15
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Asserted
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
nIOW Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted (Note 21.13)
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOW Deasserted
nIOW Asserted to nWRITE Asserted
nWAIT Asserted to Command Asserted (Note 21.13)
Command Asserted to nWAIT Deasserted
0
10
0
0
60
10
0
60
0
t16
t17
t18
t19
t20
t21
t22
PDATA Valid to Command Asserted
Ax Valid to nIOW Asserted
nIOW Asserted to Ax Invalid
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Asserted (Note 21.13)
nWAIT Asserted to PDIR Low
PDIR Low to nWRITE Asserted
10
40
10
40
60
0
0
TYP
MAX
50
185
35
190
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
12
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
24
160
70
210
10
185
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 21.13 nWAIT must be filtered to compensate for ringing on the parallel bus cable. WAIT is considered to have
settled after it does not transition for a minimum of 50 nsec.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 158
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t20
A0-A10
IOR
t19
t11
t13
t22
t12
SD<7:0>
IOCHRDY
t18
t10
t8
t24
t23
t27
PDIR
t9
t21
t17
nWRITE
t2
t25
t5
PData bus driven
by peripheral
t4
t16
PD<7:0>
t28
DATASTB
t14
t26
t1
t3
ADDRSTB
t15
t7
t6
nWAIT
Figure 21.14 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Read Cycle
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 159
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 21.3 - EPP 1.9 Data or Address Read Cycle Timing Parameters
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
PDATA Hi-Z to Command Asserted
nIOR Asserted to PDATA Hi-Z
nWAIT Deasserted to Command Deasserted (Note 21.14)
Command Deasserted to PDATA Hi-Z
Command Asserted to PDATA Valid
PDATA Hi-Z to nWAIT Deasserted
MIN
0
0
60
0
0
0
t7
t8
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
t14
t15
PDATA Valid to nWAIT Deasserted
nIOR Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
nWRITE Deasserted to nIOR Asserted (Note 21.15)
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted (Note 21.14)
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOR Deasserted
nIOR Deasserted to SDATA Hi-Z (Hold Time)
PDATA Valid to SDATA Valid
nWAIT Asserted to Command Asserted
Time Out
0
0
0
60
0
0
0
0
10
40
75
195
12
t16
t17
nWAIT Deasserted to PDATA Driven (Note 21.14)
nWAIT Deasserted to nWRITE Modified (Note 21.14, Note
21.15)
SDATA Valid to IOCHRDY Deasserted (Note 21.16)
Ax Valid to nIOR Asserted
nIOR Deasserted to Ax Invalid
nWAIT Asserted to nWRITE Deasserted
nIOR Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
nWAIT Asserted to PDIR Set (Note 21.14)
PDATA Hi-Z to PDIR Set
nWAIT Asserted to PDATA Hi-Z (Note 21.14)
PDIR Set to Command
nWAIT Deasserted to PDIR Low (Note 21.14)
nWRITE Deasserted to Command
60
60
190
190
0
40
10
0
40
60
0
60
0
60
1
85
t18
t19
t20
t21
t22
t23
t24
t25
t26
t27
t28
TYP
MAX
30
50
180
24
160
10
185
185
180
20
180
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 21.14 nWAIT is considered to have settled after it does not transition for a minimum of 50 ns.
Note 21.15 When not executing a write cycle, EPP nWRITE is inactive high.
Note 21.16 85 is true only if t7 = 0.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 160
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t18
A0-A10
t9
SD<7:0>
nIOW
t17
t8
t6
t10
t20
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
t19
t12
t11
t13
t2
t1
t5
PD<7:0>
t16
t3
t4
nDATAST
nADDRSTB
t21
nWAIT
PDIR
Figure 21.15 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Write Cycle
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 161
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Table 21.4 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Write Cycle Parameters
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
nIOW Asserted to PDATA Valid
Command Deasserted to nWRITE Change
nWRITE to Command
nIOW Deasserted to Command Deasserted (Note 21.18)
Command Deasserted to PDATA Invalid
Time Out
t8
t9
t10
t11
t12
t13
t16
t17
t18
SDATA Valid to nIOW Asserted
nIOW Deasserted to DATA Invalid
nIOW Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOW Deasserted
nIOW Asserted to nWRITE Asserted
PDATA Valid to Command Asserted
Ax Valid to nIOW Asserted
nIOW Deasserted to Ax Invalid
t19
t20
t21
nIOW Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
nWAIT Asserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Deasserted
MIN
0
0
5
50
10
10
0
0
10
0
10
40
10
TYP
MAX
50
40
35
50
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
12
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
24
40
50
35
100
45
0
µs
ns
ns
ns
Note 21.17 nWRITE is controlled by clearing the PDIR bit to "0" in the control register before performing an EPP
Write.
Note 21.18 The number is only valid if nWAIT is active when IOW goes active.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 162
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t20
A0-A10
t15
t11
t19
t22
nIOR
t13
t12
SD<7:0>
t8
t10
t3
IOCHRDY
nWRITE
t5
t4
PD<7:0>
nDATASTB
t23
t2
nADDRSTB
t21
nWAIT
PDIR
Figure 21.16 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Read Cycle
Table 21.5 - EPP 1.7 Data or Address Read Cycle Parameters
NAME
t2
t3
t4
t5
t8
t10
t11
t12
t13
t15
t19
t20
t21
t22
t23
Note:
DESCRIPTION
nIOR Deasserted to Command Deasserted
nWAIT Asserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
Command Deasserted to PDATA Hi-Z
Command Asserted to PDATA Valid
nIOR Asserted to IOCHRDY Asserted
nWAIT Deasserted to IOCHRDY Deasserted
IOCHRDY Deasserted to nIOR Deasserted
nIOR Deasserted to SDATA High-Z (Hold Time)
PDATA Valid to SDATA Valid
Time Out
Ax Valid to nIOR Asserted
nIOR Deasserted to Ax Invalid
Command Deasserted to nWAIT Deasserted
nIOR Deasserted to nIOW or nIOR Asserted
nIOR Asserted to Command Asserted
MIN
0
0
0
TYP
MAX
50
40
24
50
0
0
10
40
40
12
40
10
0
40
55
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
µs
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
WRITE is controlled by setting the PDIR bit to "1" in the control register before performing an EPP Read.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 163
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 22
ECP Parallel Port Timing
Parallel Port FIFO (Mode 101)
The standard parallel port is run at or near the peak 500KBytes/sec allowed in the forward direction using
DMA. The state machine does not examine nACK and begins the next transfer based on Busy. Refer to
Figure 22.2.
ECP Parallel Port Timing
The timing is designed to allow operation at approximately 2.0 Mbytes/sec over a 15ft cable. If a shorter
cable is used then the bandwidth will increase.
Forward-Idle
When the host has no data to send it keeps HostClk (nStrobe) high and the peripheral will leave PeriphClk
(Busy) low.
Forward Data Transfer Phase
The interface transfers data and commands from the host to the peripheral using an interlocked PeriphAck
and HostClk. The peripheral may indicate its desire to send data to the host by asserting nPeriphRequest.
The Forward Data Transfer Phase may be entered from the Forward-Idle Phase. While in the Forward
Phase the peripheral may asynchronously assert the nPeriphRequest (nFault) to request that the channel
be reversed. When the peripheral is not busy it sets PeriphAck (Busy) low. The host then sets HostClk
(nStrobe) low when it is prepared to send data. The data must be stable for the specified setup time prior
to the falling edge of HostClk. The peripheral then sets
PeriphAck (Busy) high to acknowledge the handshake. The host then sets HostClk (nStrobe) high. The
peripheral then accepts the data and sets PeriphAck (Busy) low,
completing the transfer. This sequence is shown in Figure 22.2.
The timing is designed to provide 3 cable round-trip times for data setup if Data is driven simultaneously
with HostClk (nStrobe).
Reverse-Idle Phase
The peripheral has no data to send and keeps PeriphClk high. The host is idle and keeps HostAck low.
Reverse Data Transfer Phase
The interface transfers data and commands from the peripheral to the host using an interlocked HostAck
and PeriphClk.
The Reverse Data Transfer Phase may be entered from the Reverse-Idle Phase. After the previous byte
has been accepted the host sets HostAck (nALF) low. The peripheral then sets PeriphClk (nACK) low
when it has data to send. The data must be stable for the specified setup time prior to the falling edge of
PeriphClk. When the host is ready to accept a byte it sets HostAck (nALF) high to acknowledge the
handshake. The peripheral then sets PeriphClk (nACK) high. After the host has accepted the data it sets
HostAck (nALF) low, completing the transfer. This sequence is shown in Figure 22.3.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 164
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Output Drivers
To facilitate higher performance data transfer, the use of balanced CMOS active drivers for critical signals
(Data, HostAck, HostClk, PeriphAck, PeriphClk) are used ECP Mode. Because the use of active drivers
can present compatibility problems in Compatible Mode (the control signals, by tradition, are specified as
open-collector), the drivers are dynamically changed from open-collector to totem-pole. The timing for the
dynamic driver change is specified in then IEEE 1284 Extended Capabilities Port Protocol and ISA
Interface Standard, Rev. 1.14, July 14, 1993, available from Microsoft. The dynamic driver change must
be implemented properly to prevent glitching the outputs.
t6
t3
PDATA
nSTROBE
t1
t2
t5
t4
BUSY
Figure 22.1 - Parallel Port FIFO Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
DATA Valid to nSTROBE Active
nSTROBE Active Pulse Width
DATA Hold from nSTROBE Inactive (Note 22.1)
nSTROBE Active to BUSY Active
BUSY Inactive to nSTROBE Active
BUSY Inactive to PDATA Invalid (Note 22.1)
MIN
600
600
450
TYP
MAX
500
680
80
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 22.1 The data is held until BUSY goes inactive or for time t3, whichever is longer. This only applies if another
data transfer is pending. If no other data transfer is pending, the data is held indefinitely.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 165
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t3
nAUTOFD
t4
PDATA<7:0>
t2
t1
t7
t8
nSTROBE
BUSY
t6
t5
t6
Figure 22.2 - ECP Parallel Port Forward Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
t7
t8
DESCRIPTION
nAUTOFD Valid to nSTROBE Asserted
PDATA Valid to nSTROBE Asserted
BUSY Deasserted to nAUTOFD Changed
(Note 22.2, Note 22.3)
BUSY Deasserted to PDATA Changed (Note 22.2, Note 22.3)
nSTROBE Deasserted to Busy Asserted
nSTROBE Deasserted to Busy Deasserted
BUSY Deasserted to nSTROBE Asserted (Note 22.2, Note
22.3)
BUSY Asserted to nSTROBE Deasserted (Note 22.3)
MIN
0
0
80
TYP
MAX
60
60
180
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
80
0
0
80
180
200
ns
ns
ns
ns
80
180
ns
Note 22.2 Maximum value only applies if there is data in the FIFO waiting to be written out.
Note 22.3 BUSY is not considered asserted or deasserted until it is stable for a minimum of 75 to 130 ns.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 166
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
t2
PDATA<7:0>
t1
t5
t6
nACK
t4
t3
t4
nAUTOFD
Figure 22.3 - ECP Parallel Port Reverse Timing
NAME
t1
t2
t3
t4
t5
t6
DESCRIPTION
PDATA Valid to nACK Asserted
nAUTOFD Deasserted to PDATA Changed
nACK Asserted to nAUTOFD Deasserted
(Note 22.4, Note 22.5)
nACK Deasserted to nAUTOFD Asserted (Note 22.5)
nAUTOFD Asserted to nACK Asserted
nAUTOFD Deasserted to nACK Deasserted
MIN
0
0
80
80
0
0
TYP
MAX
200
200
UNITS
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Note 22.4 Maximum value only applies if there is room in the FIFO and terminal count has not been received. ECP
can stall by keeping nAUTOFD low.
Note 22.5 nACK is not considered asserted or deasserted until it is stable for a minimum of 75 to 130 ns.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 167
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
DATA
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
t2
t1
t2
t1
IRRX
n IRRX
Parameter
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
Pulse Width at 115kbaud
Pulse Width at 57.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 38.4kbaud
Pulse Width at 19.2kbaud
Pulse Width at 9.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 4.8kbaud
Pulse Width at 2.4kbaud
Bit Time at 115kbaud
Bit Time at 57.6kbaud
Bit Time at 38.4kbaud
Bit Time at 19.2kbaud
Bit Time at 9.6kbaud
Bit Time at 4.8kbaud
Bit Time at 2.4kbaud
min
typ
max
units
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.4
1.6
3.22
4.8
9.7
19.5
39
78
8.68
17.4
26
52
104
208
416
2.71
3.69
5.53
11.07
22.13
44.27
88.55
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
Notes:
1. Receive Pulse Detection Criteria: A received pulse is considered detected if the
received pulse is a minimum of 1.41µs.
2. IRRX: L5, CRF1 Bit 0: 1 = RCV active low
nIRRX: L5, CRF1 Bit 0: 0 = RCV active high (default)
Figure 22.4 - IrDA Receive Timing
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 168
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
DATA
0
1
0
t2
t1
t2
t1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
IRTX
n IRTX
Parameter
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t1
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
t2
Pulse Width at 115kbaud
Pulse Width at 57.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 38.4kbaud
Pulse Width at 19.2kbaud
Pulse Width at 9.6kbaud
Pulse Width at 4.8kbaud
Pulse Width at 2.4kbaud
Bit Time at 115kbaud
Bit Time at 57.6kbaud
Bit Time at 38.4kbaud
Bit Time at 19.2kbaud
Bit Time at 9.6kbaud
Bit Time at 4.8kbaud
Bit Time at 2.4kbaud
min
typ
max
units
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.41
1.6
3.22
4.8
9.7
19.5
39
78
8.68
17.4
26
52
104
208
416
2.71
3.69
5.53
11.07
22.13
44.27
88.55
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
Notes:
1. IrDA @ 115k is HPSIR compatible. IrDA @ 2400 will allow compatibility with HP95LX
and 48SX.
2. IRTX: L5, CRF1 Bit 1: 1 = XMIT active low (default)
nIRTX: L5, CRF1 Bit 1: 0 = XMIT active high
Figure 22.5 - IrDA Transmit Timing
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 169
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
D A TA
0
1
t1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
t2
IR R X
n IR R X
t3
t4
t5
t6
M IR R X
nM IR R X
P aram eter
m in
typ
m ax
units
t1
M odulated O utput B it Tim e
t2
O ff B it Tim e
t3
M odulated O utput "O n"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t4
M odulated O utput "O ff"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t5
M odulated O utput "O n"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t6
M odulated O utput "O ff"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
µs
µs
N otes:
1. IR R X :
L5, C R F1 B it 0: 1 = R C V active low
nIR R X : L5, C R F1 B it 0: 0 = R C V active high (default)
M IR R X , nM IR R X are the m odulated outputs
Figure 22.6 - Amplitude Shift Keyed IR Receive Timing
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 170
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
DATA
0
1
t1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
t2
IRTX
n
t3
t4
t5
t6
MIRTX
nMIRTX
Parameter
min
typ
max
units
t1
Modulated Output Bit Time
t2
Off Bit Time
µs
t3
Modulated Output "On"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t4
Modulated Output "Off"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t5
Modulated Output "On"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
t6
Modulated Output "Off"
0.8
1
1.2
µs
µs
Notes:
1. IRTX:
L5, CRF1 Bit 1: 1 = XMIT active low (default)
nIRTX: L5, CRF1 Bit 1: 0 = XMIT active high
MIRTX, nMIRTX are the modulated outputs
Figure 22.7 - Amplitude Shift Keyed IR Transmit Timing
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 171
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Chapter 23 Package Outlines
D
D1
E
e
E1
W
A
A2
T D /T E
H
0 .10
-C-
D IM
A
A1
A2
D
D1
E
E1
H
L
L1
e
0
W
T D (1 )
T E (1 )
T D (2 )
T E (2 )
0
A1
L
L1
M IN
2 .8 0
0 .1
2 .5 7
MAX
3 .1 5
0 .4 5
2 .8 7
M IN
.1 1 0
.0 0 4
.1 0 1
M AX
.1 2 4
.0 1 8
.1 1 3
2 3 .4
1 9 .9
1 7 .4
1 3 .9
2 4 .1 5
2 0 .1
1 8 .1 5
1 4 .1
.9 2 1
.7 8 3
.6 8 5
.5 4 7
.9 5 1
.7 9 1
.7 1 5
.5 5 5
0 .1
0 .2
0 .6 5
0 .9 5
1 .8
2 .6
0 .6 5 B S C
0°
12°
.4
.2
2 1 .8
1 5 .8
2 2 .2 1
1 6 .2 7
2 2 .2
1 6 .2
2 2 .7 6
1 6 .8 2
.0 0 4
.0 0 8
.0 2 6
.0 3 7
.1 0 2
.0 7 1
.0 2 5 6 B S C
0°
12°
.0 0 8
.0 1 6
.8 5 8
.6 2 2
.8 7 4
.6 4 1
N o te s:
1 ) C o p la n a rity is 0 .1 0 0 m m (.0 0 4 ") m a xim u m .
2 ) T o le ra n ce o n th e p o sitio n o f th e le a d s is
0 .2 0 0 m m (.0 0 8 ") m a xim u m .
3 ) P a cka g e b o d y d im e n sio n s D 1 a n d E 1 d o n o t
in clu d e th e m o ld p ro tru sio n . M a xim u m m o ld
p ro tru sio n is 0 .2 5 m m (.0 1 0 ").
4 ) D im e n sio n s T D a n d TE a re im p o rta n t fo r te stin g
b y ro b o tic h a n d le r. O n ly a b o ve co m b in a tio n s o f (1 )
o r (2 ) a re a cce p ta b le .
5 ) C o n tro llin g d im e n sio n : m illim e te r. D im e n sio n s
in in ch e s fo r re fe re n ce o n ly a n d n o t n e ce ssa rily
a ccu ra te .
.8 7 4
.6 3 8
.8 9 6
.6 6 2
Figure 23.1 - 100 Pin QFP Package Outline and Parameters
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 172
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Enhanced Super I/O Controller with Fast IR
Datasheet
Figure 23.2 - 100 Pin TQFP Package Outline, 14X14X1.4 Body, 2 MM Footprint
Table 23.1 - 100 Pin TQFP Package Parameters
A
A1
A2
D
D1
E
E1
H
L
L1
e
θ
W
R1
R2
ccc
MIN
~
0.05
1.35
15.80
13.90
15.80
13.90
0.09
0.45
~
0o
0.17
0.08
0.08
~
NOMINAL
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
~
0.60
1.00
0.50 Basic
~
0.22
~
~
~
MAX
1.60
0.15
1.45
16.20
14.10
16.20
14.10
0.20
0.75
~
REMARKS
Overall Package Height
Standoff
Body Thickness
X Span
X body Size
Y Span
Y body Size
Lead Frame Thickness
Lead Foot Length
Lead Length
Lead Pitch
Lead Foot Angle
Lead Width
Lead Shoulder Radius
Lead Foot Radius
Coplanarity
7o
0.27
~
0.20
0.08
Notes:
1. Controlling Unit: millimeter.
2. Tolerance on the position of the leads is ± 0.04 mm maximum.
3. Package body dimensions D1 and E1 do not include the mold protrusion.
Maximum mold protrusion is 0.25 mm.
4. Dimension for foot length L measured at the gauge plane 0.25 mm above the seating plane.
5. Details of pin 1 identifier are optional but must be located within the zone indicated.
SMSC FDC37C672
Page 173
DATASHEET
Rev. 10-29-03
Similar pages